summaryrefslogtreecommitdiffstats
path: root/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
Diffstat (limited to 'gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib')
-rw-r--r--gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/Makefile14
-rw-r--r--gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/conf.h400
-rw-r--r--gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/maketime.c344
-rw-r--r--gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/maketime.h39
-rw-r--r--gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/merger.c148
-rw-r--r--gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/partime.c701
-rw-r--r--gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/partime.h71
-rw-r--r--gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsbase.h762
-rw-r--r--gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsedit.c1958
-rw-r--r--gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsfcmp.c354
-rw-r--r--gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsfnms.c1132
-rw-r--r--gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsgen.c681
-rw-r--r--gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcskeep.c452
-rw-r--r--gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcskeys.c186
-rw-r--r--gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcslex.c1568
-rw-r--r--gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsmap.c69
-rw-r--r--gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsrev.c911
-rw-r--r--gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcssyn.c681
-rw-r--r--gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcstime.c191
-rw-r--r--gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsutil.c1398
-rw-r--r--gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/version.c2
21 files changed, 0 insertions, 12062 deletions
diff --git a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/Makefile b/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/Makefile
deleted file mode 100644
index f21fda1..0000000
--- a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/Makefile
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,14 +0,0 @@
-# $FreeBSD$
-
-# Define FSYNC_ALL to get slower but safer writes in case of crashes in
-# the middle of CVS/RCS changes
-#CFLAGS += -DFSYNC_ALL
-
-LIB = rcs
-SRCS = maketime.c partime.c rcsedit.c rcsfcmp.c rcsfnms.c rcsgen.c \
- rcskeep.c rcskeys.c rcslex.c rcsmap.c rcsrev.c rcssyn.c rcstime.c \
- rcsutil.c merger.c version.c
-
-INTERNALLIB=
-
-.include <bsd.lib.mk>
diff --git a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/conf.h b/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/conf.h
deleted file mode 100644
index 96ec07d..0000000
--- a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/conf.h
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,400 +0,0 @@
-/* RCS compile-time configuration */
-
- /* $FreeBSD$ */
-
-/*
- * This file is generated automatically.
- * If you edit it by hand your changes may be lost.
- * Instead, please try to fix conf.sh,
- * and send your fixes to rcs-bugs@cs.purdue.edu.
- */
-
-#define exitmain(n) return n /* how to exit from main() */
-/* #define _POSIX_C_SOURCE 2147483647L */ /* if strict C + Posix 1003.1b-1993 or later */
-/* #define _POSIX_SOURCE */ /* if strict C + Posix 1003.1-1990 */
-
-#include <errno.h>
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <time.h>
-
-/* Comment out #include lines below that do not work. */
-#include <sys/types.h>
-#include <sys/stat.h>
-#include <dirent.h>
-#include <fcntl.h>
-#include <limits.h>
-/* #include <mach/mach.h> */
-/* #include <net/errno.h> */
-#include <pwd.h>
-/* #include <siginfo.h> */
-#include <signal.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <string.h>
-#include <sys/mman.h>
-#include <sys/wait.h>
-/* #include <ucontext.h> */
-#include <unistd.h>
-#include <utime.h>
-/* #include <vfork.h> */
-
-/* Define boolean symbols to be 0 (false, the default), or 1 (true). */
-#define has_sys_param_h 1 /* Does #include <sys/param.h> work? */
-/* extern int errno; */ /* Uncomment if <errno.h> doesn't declare errno. */
-#define has_readlink 1 /* Does readlink() work? */
-#define readlink_isreg_errno EINVAL /* errno after readlink on regular file */
-
-#if has_readlink && !defined(MAXSYMLINKS)
-# if has_sys_param_h
-# include <sys/param.h>
-# endif
-# ifndef MAXSYMLINKS
-# define MAXSYMLINKS 20 /* BSD; not standard yet */
-# endif
-#endif
-
-/* Comment out the typedefs below if the types are already declared. */
-/* Fix any uncommented typedefs that are wrong. */
-/* typedef int mode_t; */
-/* typedef long off_t; */
-/* typedef int pid_t; */
-/* typedef int sig_atomic_t; */
-/* typedef unsigned size_t; */
-/* typedef int ssize_t; */
-/* typedef long time_t; */
-/* typedef int uid_t; */
-
-/* Comment out the keyword definitions below if the keywords work. */
-/* #define const */
-/* #define volatile */
-
-/* Define boolean symbols to be 0 (false, the default), or 1 (true). */
-#define has_prototypes 1 /* Do function prototypes work? */
-#define has_stdarg 1 /* Does <stdarg.h> work? */
-/* #define has_varargs ? */ /* Does <varargs.h> work? */
-#define va_start_args 2 /* How many args does va_start() take? */
-
-#if O_BINARY
- /* Text and binary i/o behave differently. */
- /* This is incompatible with Posix and Unix. */
-# define FOPEN_RB "rb"
-# define FOPEN_R_WORK (Expand==BINARY_EXPAND ? "r" : "rb")
-# define FOPEN_WB "wb"
-# define FOPEN_W_WORK (Expand==BINARY_EXPAND ? "w" : "wb")
-# define FOPEN_WPLUS_WORK (Expand==BINARY_EXPAND ? "w+" : "w+b")
-# define OPEN_O_BINARY O_BINARY
-#else
- /*
- * Text and binary i/o behave the same.
- * Omit "b", since some nonstandard hosts reject it.
- */
-# define FOPEN_RB "r"
-# define FOPEN_R_WORK "r"
-# define FOPEN_WB "w"
-# define FOPEN_W_WORK "w"
-# define FOPEN_WPLUS_WORK "w+"
-# define OPEN_O_BINARY 0
-#endif
-
-/* This may need changing on non-Unix systems (notably DOS). */
-#define OPEN_CREAT_READONLY (S_IRUSR|S_IRGRP|S_IROTH) /* lock file mode */
-#define OPEN_O_LOCK 0 /* extra open flags for creating lock file */
-#define OPEN_O_WRONLY O_WRONLY /* main open flag for creating a lock file */
-
-/* Define or comment out the following symbols as needed. */
-#if has_prototypes
-# define P(params) params
-#else
-# define P(params) ()
-#endif
-#if has_stdarg
-# include <stdarg.h>
-#else
-# if has_varargs
-# include <varargs.h>
-# else
- typedef char *va_list;
-# define va_dcl int va_alist;
-# define va_start(ap) ((ap) = (va_list)&va_alist)
-# define va_arg(ap,t) (((t*) ((ap)+=sizeof(t))) [-1])
-# define va_end(ap)
-# endif
-#endif
-#if va_start_args == 2
-# define vararg_start va_start
-#else
-# define vararg_start(ap,p) va_start(ap)
-#endif
-#define bad_chmod_close 0 /* Can chmod() close file descriptors? */
-#define bad_creat0 0 /* Do writes fail after creat(f,0)? */
-#define bad_fopen_wplus 0 /* Does fopen(f,"w+") fail to truncate f? */
-#define getlogin_is_secure 0 /* Is getlogin() secure? Usually it's not. */
-#define has_attribute_noreturn 1 /* Does __attribute__((noreturn)) work? */
-#if has_attribute_noreturn
-# define exiting __attribute__((noreturn))
-#else
-# define exiting
-#endif
-#define has_dirent 1 /* Do opendir(), readdir(), closedir() work? */
-#define void_closedir 0 /* Does closedir() yield void? */
-#define has_fchmod 1 /* Does fchmod() work? */
-#define has_fflush_input 0 /* Does fflush() work on input files? */
-#define has_fputs 1 /* Does fputs() work? */
-#define has_ftruncate 1 /* Does ftruncate() work? */
-#define has_getuid 1 /* Does getuid() work? */
-#define has_getpwuid 1 /* Does getpwuid() work? */
-#define has_memcmp 1 /* Does memcmp() work? */
-#define has_memcpy 1 /* Does memcpy() work? */
-#define has_memmove 1 /* Does memmove() work? */
-#define has_map_fd 0 /* Does map_fd() work? */
-#define has_mmap 1 /* Does mmap() work on regular files? */
-#define has_madvise 0 /* Does madvise() work? */
-#define mmap_signal SIGBUS /* signal received if you reference nonexistent part of mmapped file */
-#define has_rename 1 /* Does rename() work? */
-#define bad_a_rename 0 /* Does rename(A,B) fail if A is unwritable? */
-#define bad_b_rename 0 /* Does rename(A,B) fail if B is unwritable? */
-#define bad_NFS_rename 0 /* Can rename(A,B) falsely report success? */
-/* typedef int void; */ /* Some ancient compilers need this. */
-#define VOID (void) /* 'VOID e;' discards the value of an expression 'e'. */
-#define has_seteuid 1 /* Does seteuid() work? See ../INSTALL.RCS. */
-#define has_setreuid 0 /* Does setreuid() work? See ../INSTALL.RCS. */
-#define has_setuid 1 /* Does setuid() exist? */
-#define has_sigaction 1 /* Does struct sigaction work? */
-#define has_sa_sigaction 1 /* Does struct sigaction have sa_sigaction? */
-#define has_signal 1 /* Does signal() work? */
-#define signal_type void /* type returned by signal handlers */
-#define sig_zaps_handler 0 /* Must a signal handler reinvoke signal()? */
-/* #define has_sigblock ? */ /* Does sigblock() work? */
-/* #define sigmask(s) (1 << ((s)-1)) */ /* Yield mask for signal number. */
-typedef size_t fread_type; /* type returned by fread() and fwrite() */
-typedef size_t freadarg_type; /* type of their size arguments */
-typedef void *malloc_type; /* type returned by malloc() */
-#define has_getcwd 1 /* Does getcwd() work? */
-/* #define has_getwd ? */ /* Does getwd() work? */
-#define needs_getabsname 0 /* Must we define getabsname? */
-#define has_mktemp 1 /* Does mktemp() work? */
-#define has_mkstemp 1 /* Does mkstemp() work? */
-#define has_NFS 1 /* Might NFS be used? */
-#define has_psiginfo 0 /* Does psiginfo() work? */
-#define has_psignal 1 /* Does psignal() work? */
-/* #define has_si_errno ? */ /* Does siginfo_t have si_errno? */
-/* #define has_sys_siglist ? */ /* Does sys_siglist[] work? */
-/* #define strchr index */ /* Use old-fashioned name for strchr()? */
-/* #define strrchr rindex */ /* Use old-fashioned name for strrchr()? */
-#define bad_unlink 0 /* Does unlink() fail on unwritable files? */
-#define has_vfork 1 /* Does vfork() work? */
-#define has_fork 1 /* Does fork() work? */
-#define has_spawn 0 /* Does spawn*() work? */
-#define has_waitpid 1 /* Does waitpid() work? */
-#define bad_wait_if_SIGCHLD_ignored 0 /* Does ignoring SIGCHLD break wait()? */
-#define RCS_SHELL "/bin/sh" /* shell to run RCS subprograms */
-#define has_printf_dot 1 /* Does "%.2d" print leading 0? */
-#define has_vfprintf 1 /* Does vfprintf() work? */
-#define has_attribute_format_printf 1 /* Does __attribute__((format(printf,N,N+1))) work? */
-#if has_attribute_format_printf
-# define printf_string(m, n) __attribute__((format(printf, m, n)))
-#else
-# define printf_string(m, n)
-#endif
-#if has_attribute_format_printf && has_attribute_noreturn
- /* Work around a bug in GCC 2.5.x. */
-# define printf_string_exiting(m, n) __attribute__((format(printf, m, n), noreturn))
-#else
-# define printf_string_exiting(m, n) printf_string(m, n) exiting
-#endif
-/* #define has__doprintf ? */ /* Does _doprintf() work? */
-/* #define has__doprnt ? */ /* Does _doprnt() work? */
-/* #undef EXIT_FAILURE */ /* Uncomment this if EXIT_FAILURE is broken. */
-#define large_memory 1 /* Can main memory hold entire RCS files? */
-#ifndef LONG_MAX
-#define LONG_MAX 2147483647L /* long maximum */
-#endif
-/* Do struct stat s and t describe the same file? Answer d if unknown. */
-#define same_file(s,t,d) ((s).st_ino==(t).st_ino && (s).st_dev==(t).st_dev)
-#define has_utimbuf 1 /* Does struct utimbuf work? */
-#define CO "/usr/bin/co" /* name of 'co' program */
-#define COMPAT2 0 /* Are version 2 files supported? */
-#define DIFF "/usr/bin/diff" /* name of 'diff' program */
-#define DIFF3 "/usr/bin/diff3" /* name of 'diff3' program */
-#define DIFF3_BIN 1 /* Is diff3 user-visible (not the /usr/lib auxiliary)? */
-#define DIFFFLAGS "-an" /* Make diff output suitable for RCS. */
-#define DIFF_L 1 /* Does diff -L work? */
-#define DIFF_SUCCESS 0 /* DIFF status if no differences are found */
-#define DIFF_FAILURE 1 /* DIFF status if differences are found */
-#define DIFF_TROUBLE 2 /* DIFF status if trouble */
-#define ED "/bin/ed" /* name of 'ed' program (used only if !DIFF3_BIN) */
-#define MERGE "/usr/bin/merge" /* name of 'merge' program */
-#define TMPDIR "/tmp" /* default directory for temporary files */
-#define SLASH '/' /* principal filename separator */
-#define SLASHes '/' /* `case SLASHes:' labels all filename separators */
-#define isSLASH(c) ((c) == SLASH) /* Is arg a filename separator? */
-#define ROOTPATH(p) isSLASH((p)[0]) /* Is p an absolute pathname? */
-#define X_DEFAULT ",v/" /* default value for -x option */
-#define SLASHSLASH_is_SLASH 1 /* Are // and / the same directory? */
-#define ALL_ABSOLUTE 1 /* Do all subprograms satisfy ROOTPATH? */
-#define DIFF_ABSOLUTE 1 /* Is ROOTPATH(DIFF) true? */
-#define SENDMAIL "/usr/sbin/sendmail" /* how to send mail */
-#define TZ_must_be_set 0 /* Must TZ be set for gmtime() to work? */
-
-
-
-/* Adjust the following declarations as needed. */
-
-
-/* The rest is for the benefit of non-standard, traditional hosts. */
-/* Don't bother to declare functions that in traditional hosts do not appear, */
-/* or are declared in .h files, or return int or void. */
-
-
-/* traditional BSD */
-
-#if has_sys_siglist && !defined(sys_siglist)
- extern char const * const sys_siglist[];
-#endif
-
-
-/* Posix (ISO/IEC 9945-1: 1990 / IEEE Std 1003.1-1990) */
-
-/* <fcntl.h> */
-#ifdef O_CREAT
-# define open_can_creat 1
-#else
-# define open_can_creat 0
-# define O_RDONLY 0
-# define O_WRONLY 1
-# define O_RDWR 2
-# define O_CREAT 01000
-# define O_TRUNC 02000
-#endif
-#ifndef O_EXCL
-#define O_EXCL 0
-#endif
-
-/* <sys/stat.h> */
-#ifndef S_IRUSR
-# ifdef S_IREAD
-# define S_IRUSR S_IREAD
-# else
-# define S_IRUSR 0400
-# endif
-# ifdef S_IWRITE
-# define S_IWUSR S_IWRITE
-# else
-# define S_IWUSR (S_IRUSR/2)
-# endif
-#endif
-#ifndef S_IRGRP
-# if has_getuid
-# define S_IRGRP (S_IRUSR / 0010)
-# define S_IWGRP (S_IWUSR / 0010)
-# define S_IROTH (S_IRUSR / 0100)
-# define S_IWOTH (S_IWUSR / 0100)
-# else
- /* single user OS -- not Posix or Unix */
-# define S_IRGRP 0
-# define S_IWGRP 0
-# define S_IROTH 0
-# define S_IWOTH 0
-# endif
-#endif
-#ifndef S_ISREG
-#define S_ISREG(n) (((n) & S_IFMT) == S_IFREG)
-#endif
-
-/* <sys/wait.h> */
-#ifndef WEXITSTATUS
-#define WEXITSTATUS(stat_val) ((unsigned)(stat_val) >> 8)
-#undef WIFEXITED /* Avoid 4.3BSD incompatibility with Posix. */
-#endif
-#ifndef WIFEXITED
-#define WIFEXITED(stat_val) (((stat_val) & 0377) == 0)
-#endif
-#ifndef WTERMSIG
-#define WTERMSIG(stat_val) ((stat_val) & 0177)
-#undef WIFSIGNALED /* Avoid 4.3BSD incompatibility with Posix. */
-#endif
-#ifndef WIFSIGNALED
-#define WIFSIGNALED(stat_val) ((unsigned)(stat_val) - 1 < 0377)
-#endif
-
-/* <unistd.h> */
-char *getlogin P((void));
-#ifndef STDIN_FILENO
-# define STDIN_FILENO 0
-# define STDOUT_FILENO 1
-# define STDERR_FILENO 2
-#endif
-#if has_fork && !has_vfork
-# undef vfork
-# define vfork fork
-#endif
-#if has_getcwd || !has_getwd
- char *getcwd P((char*,size_t));
-#else
- char *getwd P((char*));
-#endif
-#if has_setuid && !has_seteuid
-# undef seteuid
-# define seteuid setuid
-#endif
-#if has_spawn
-# if ALL_ABSOLUTE
-# define spawn_RCS spawnv
-# else
-# define spawn_RCS spawnvp
-# endif
-#else
-# if ALL_ABSOLUTE
-# define exec_RCS execv
-# else
-# define exec_RCS execvp
-# endif
-#endif
-
-/* utime.h */
-#if !has_utimbuf
- struct utimbuf { time_t actime, modtime; };
-#endif
-
-
-/* Standard C library */
-
-/* <stdio.h> */
-#ifndef L_tmpnam
-#define L_tmpnam 32 /* power of 2 > sizeof("/usr/tmp/xxxxxxxxxxxxxxx") */
-#endif
-#ifndef SEEK_SET
-#define SEEK_SET 0
-#endif
-#ifndef SEEK_CUR
-#define SEEK_CUR 1
-#endif
-#if has_mktemp
- char *mktemp P((char*)); /* traditional */
-#else
- char *tmpnam P((char*));
-#endif
-
-/* <stdlib.h> */
-char *getenv P((char const*));
-void _exit P((int)) exiting;
-void exit P((int)) exiting;
-malloc_type malloc P((size_t));
-malloc_type realloc P((malloc_type,size_t));
-#ifndef EXIT_FAILURE
-#define EXIT_FAILURE 1
-#endif
-#ifndef EXIT_SUCCESS
-#define EXIT_SUCCESS 0
-#endif
-
-/* <string.h> */
-char *strcpy P((char*,char const*));
-char *strchr P((char const*,int));
-char *strrchr P((char const*,int));
-void *memcpy P((void*,void const*,size_t));
-#if has_memmove
- void *memmove P((void*,void const*,size_t));
-#endif
-
-/* <time.h> */
-time_t time P((time_t*));
diff --git a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/maketime.c b/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/maketime.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 0f83bf5..0000000
--- a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/maketime.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,344 +0,0 @@
-/* Convert struct partime into time_t. */
-
-/* Copyright 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995 Paul Eggert
- Distributed under license by the Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-
-This file is part of RCS.
-
-RCS is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
-it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
-any later version.
-
-RCS is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
-GNU General Public License for more details.
-
-You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-along with RCS; see the file COPYING.
-If not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
-59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
-
-Report problems and direct all questions to:
-
- rcs-bugs@cs.purdue.edu
-
-*/
-
-#if has_conf_h
-# include "conf.h"
-#else
-# ifdef __STDC__
-# define P(x) x
-# else
-# define const
-# define P(x) ()
-# endif
-# include <stdlib.h>
-# include <time.h>
-#endif
-
-#include "partime.h"
-#include "maketime.h"
-
-char const maketId[]
- = "$FreeBSD$";
-
-static int isleap P((int));
-static int month_days P((struct tm const*));
-static time_t maketime P((struct partime const*,time_t));
-
-/*
-* For maximum portability, use only localtime and gmtime.
-* Make no assumptions about the time_t epoch or the range of time_t values.
-* Avoid mktime because it's not universal and because there's no easy,
-* portable way for mktime to yield the inverse of gmtime.
-*/
-
-#define TM_YEAR_ORIGIN 1900
-
- static int
-isleap(y)
- int y;
-{
- return (y&3) == 0 && (y%100 != 0 || y%400 == 0);
-}
-
-static int const month_yday[] = {
- /* days in year before start of months 0-12 */
- 0, 31, 59, 90, 120, 151, 181, 212, 243, 273, 304, 334, 365
-};
-
-/* Yield the number of days in TM's month. */
- static int
-month_days(tm)
- struct tm const *tm;
-{
- int m = tm->tm_mon;
- return month_yday[m+1] - month_yday[m]
- + (m==1 && isleap(tm->tm_year + TM_YEAR_ORIGIN));
-}
-
-/*
-* Convert UNIXTIME to struct tm form.
-* Use gmtime if available and if !LOCALZONE, localtime otherwise.
-*/
- struct tm *
-time2tm(unixtime, localzone)
- time_t unixtime;
- int localzone;
-{
- struct tm *tm;
-# if TZ_must_be_set
- static char const *TZ;
- if (!TZ && !(TZ = getenv("TZ")))
- faterror("The TZ environment variable is not set; please set it to your timezone");
-# endif
- if (localzone || !(tm = gmtime(&unixtime)))
- tm = localtime(&unixtime);
- return tm;
-}
-
-/* Yield A - B, measured in seconds. */
- time_t
-difftm(a, b)
- struct tm const *a, *b;
-{
- int ay = a->tm_year + (TM_YEAR_ORIGIN - 1);
- int by = b->tm_year + (TM_YEAR_ORIGIN - 1);
- int difference_in_day_of_year = a->tm_yday - b->tm_yday;
- int intervening_leap_days = (
- ((ay >> 2) - (by >> 2))
- - (ay/100 - by/100)
- + ((ay/100 >> 2) - (by/100 >> 2))
- );
- time_t difference_in_years = ay - by;
- time_t difference_in_days = (
- difference_in_years*365
- + (intervening_leap_days + difference_in_day_of_year)
- );
- return
- (
- (
- 24*difference_in_days
- + (a->tm_hour - b->tm_hour)
- )*60 + (a->tm_min - b->tm_min)
- )*60 + (a->tm_sec - b->tm_sec);
-}
-
-/*
-* Adjust time T by adding SECONDS. SECONDS must be at most 24 hours' worth.
-* Adjust only T's year, mon, mday, hour, min and sec members;
-* plus adjust wday if it is defined.
-*/
- void
-adjzone(t, seconds)
- register struct tm *t;
- long seconds;
-{
- /*
- * This code can be off by a second if SECONDS is not a multiple of 60,
- * if T is local time, and if a leap second happens during this minute.
- * But this bug has never occurred, and most likely will not ever occur.
- * Liberia, the last country for which SECONDS % 60 was nonzero,
- * switched to UTC in May 1972; the first leap second was in June 1972.
- */
- int leap_second = t->tm_sec == 60;
- long sec = seconds + (t->tm_sec - leap_second);
- if (sec < 0) {
- if ((t->tm_min -= (59-sec)/60) < 0) {
- if ((t->tm_hour -= (59-t->tm_min)/60) < 0) {
- t->tm_hour += 24;
- if (TM_DEFINED(t->tm_wday) && --t->tm_wday < 0)
- t->tm_wday = 6;
- if (--t->tm_mday <= 0) {
- if (--t->tm_mon < 0) {
- --t->tm_year;
- t->tm_mon = 11;
- }
- t->tm_mday = month_days(t);
- }
- }
- t->tm_min += 24 * 60;
- }
- sec += 24L * 60 * 60;
- } else
- if (60 <= (t->tm_min += sec/60))
- if (24 <= (t->tm_hour += t->tm_min/60)) {
- t->tm_hour -= 24;
- if (TM_DEFINED(t->tm_wday) && ++t->tm_wday == 7)
- t->tm_wday = 0;
- if (month_days(t) < ++t->tm_mday) {
- if (11 < ++t->tm_mon) {
- ++t->tm_year;
- t->tm_mon = 0;
- }
- t->tm_mday = 1;
- }
- }
- t->tm_min %= 60;
- t->tm_sec = (int) (sec%60) + leap_second;
-}
-
-/*
-* Convert TM to time_t, using localtime if LOCALZONE and gmtime otherwise.
-* Use only TM's year, mon, mday, hour, min, and sec members.
-* Ignore TM's old tm_yday and tm_wday, but fill in their correct values.
-* Yield -1 on failure (e.g. a member out of range).
-* Posix 1003.1-1990 doesn't allow leap seconds, but some implementations
-* have them anyway, so allow them if localtime/gmtime does.
-*/
- time_t
-tm2time(tm, localzone)
- struct tm *tm;
- int localzone;
-{
- /* Cache the most recent t,tm pairs; 1 for gmtime, 1 for localtime. */
- static time_t t_cache[2];
- static struct tm tm_cache[2];
-
- time_t d, gt;
- struct tm const *gtm;
- /*
- * The maximum number of iterations should be enough to handle any
- * combinations of leap seconds, time zone rule changes, and solar time.
- * 4 is probably enough; we use a bigger number just to be safe.
- */
- int remaining_tries = 8;
-
- /* Avoid subscript errors. */
- if (12 <= (unsigned)tm->tm_mon)
- return -1;
-
- tm->tm_yday = month_yday[tm->tm_mon] + tm->tm_mday
- - (tm->tm_mon<2 || ! isleap(tm->tm_year + TM_YEAR_ORIGIN));
-
- /* Make a first guess. */
- gt = t_cache[localzone];
- gtm = gt ? &tm_cache[localzone] : time2tm(gt,localzone);
-
- /* Repeatedly use the error from the guess to improve the guess. */
- while ((d = difftm(tm, gtm)) != 0) {
- if (--remaining_tries == 0)
- return -1;
- gt += d;
- gtm = time2tm(gt,localzone);
- }
- t_cache[localzone] = gt;
- tm_cache[localzone] = *gtm;
-
- /*
- * Check that the guess actually matches;
- * overflow can cause difftm to yield 0 even on differing times,
- * or tm may have members out of range (e.g. bad leap seconds).
- */
- if ( (tm->tm_year ^ gtm->tm_year)
- | (tm->tm_mon ^ gtm->tm_mon)
- | (tm->tm_mday ^ gtm->tm_mday)
- | (tm->tm_hour ^ gtm->tm_hour)
- | (tm->tm_min ^ gtm->tm_min)
- | (tm->tm_sec ^ gtm->tm_sec))
- return -1;
-
- tm->tm_wday = gtm->tm_wday;
- return gt;
-}
-
-/*
-* Check *PT and convert it to time_t.
-* If it is incompletely specified, use DEFAULT_TIME to fill it out.
-* Use localtime if PT->zone is the special value TM_LOCAL_ZONE.
-* Yield -1 on failure.
-* ISO 8601 day-of-year and week numbers are not yet supported.
-*/
- static time_t
-maketime(pt, default_time)
- struct partime const *pt;
- time_t default_time;
-{
- int localzone, wday;
- struct tm tm;
- struct tm *tm0 = 0;
- time_t r;
-
- tm0 = 0; /* Keep gcc -Wall happy. */
- localzone = pt->zone==TM_LOCAL_ZONE;
-
- tm = pt->tm;
-
- if (TM_DEFINED(pt->ymodulus) || !TM_DEFINED(tm.tm_year)) {
- /* Get tm corresponding to current time. */
- tm0 = time2tm(default_time, localzone);
- if (!localzone)
- adjzone(tm0, pt->zone);
- }
-
- if (TM_DEFINED(pt->ymodulus))
- tm.tm_year +=
- (tm0->tm_year + TM_YEAR_ORIGIN)/pt->ymodulus * pt->ymodulus;
- else if (!TM_DEFINED(tm.tm_year)) {
- /* Set default year, month, day from current time. */
- tm.tm_year = tm0->tm_year + TM_YEAR_ORIGIN;
- if (!TM_DEFINED(tm.tm_mon)) {
- tm.tm_mon = tm0->tm_mon;
- if (!TM_DEFINED(tm.tm_mday))
- tm.tm_mday = tm0->tm_mday;
- }
- }
-
- /* Convert from partime year (Gregorian) to Posix year. */
- tm.tm_year -= TM_YEAR_ORIGIN;
-
- /* Set remaining default fields to be their minimum values. */
- if (!TM_DEFINED(tm.tm_mon)) tm.tm_mon = 0;
- if (!TM_DEFINED(tm.tm_mday)) tm.tm_mday = 1;
- if (!TM_DEFINED(tm.tm_hour)) tm.tm_hour = 0;
- if (!TM_DEFINED(tm.tm_min)) tm.tm_min = 0;
- if (!TM_DEFINED(tm.tm_sec)) tm.tm_sec = 0;
-
- if (!localzone)
- adjzone(&tm, -pt->zone);
- wday = tm.tm_wday;
-
- /* Convert and fill in the rest of the tm. */
- r = tm2time(&tm, localzone);
-
- /* Check weekday. */
- if (r != -1 && TM_DEFINED(wday) && wday != tm.tm_wday)
- return -1;
-
- return r;
-}
-
-/* Parse a free-format date in SOURCE, yielding a Unix format time. */
- time_t
-str2time(source, default_time, default_zone)
- char const *source;
- time_t default_time;
- long default_zone;
-{
- struct partime pt;
-
- if (*partime(source, &pt))
- return -1;
- if (pt.zone == TM_UNDEFINED_ZONE)
- pt.zone = default_zone;
- return maketime(&pt, default_time);
-}
-
-#if TEST
-#include <stdio.h>
- int
-main(argc, argv) int argc; char **argv;
-{
- time_t default_time = time((time_t *)0);
- long default_zone = argv[1] ? atol(argv[1]) : 0;
- char buf[1000];
- while (fgets(buf, 1000, stdin)) {
- time_t t = str2time(buf, default_time, default_zone);
- printf("%s", asctime(gmtime(&t)));
- }
- return 0;
-}
-#endif
diff --git a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/maketime.h b/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/maketime.h
deleted file mode 100644
index fbe1256..0000000
--- a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/maketime.h
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,39 +0,0 @@
-/* Yield time_t from struct partime yielded by partime. */
-
-/* Copyright 1993, 1994, 1995 Paul Eggert
- Distributed under license by the Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-
-This file is part of RCS.
-
-RCS is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
-it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
-any later version.
-
-RCS is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
-GNU General Public License for more details.
-
-You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-along with RCS; see the file COPYING.
-If not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
-59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
-
-Report problems and direct all questions to:
-
- rcs-bugs@cs.purdue.edu
-
-*/
-
-#if defined(__STDC__) || has_prototypes
-# define __MAKETIME_P(x) x
-#else
-# define __MAKETIME_P(x) ()
-#endif
-
-struct tm *time2tm __MAKETIME_P((time_t,int));
-time_t difftm __MAKETIME_P((struct tm const *, struct tm const *));
-time_t str2time __MAKETIME_P((char const *, time_t, long));
-time_t tm2time __MAKETIME_P((struct tm *, int));
-void adjzone __MAKETIME_P((struct tm *, long));
diff --git a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/merger.c b/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/merger.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 8f1d610..0000000
--- a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/merger.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,148 +0,0 @@
-/* three-way file merge internals */
-
-/* Copyright 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995 Paul Eggert
- Distributed under license by the Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-
-This file is part of RCS.
-
-RCS is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
-it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
-any later version.
-
-RCS is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
-GNU General Public License for more details.
-
-You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-along with RCS; see the file COPYING.
-If not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
-59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
-
-Report problems and direct all questions to:
-
- rcs-bugs@cs.purdue.edu
-
-*/
-
-#include "rcsbase.h"
-
-libId(mergerId, "$FreeBSD$")
-
- static char const *normalize_arg P((char const*,char**));
- static char const *
-normalize_arg(s, b)
- char const *s;
- char **b;
-/*
- * If S looks like an option, prepend ./ to it. Yield the result.
- * Set *B to the address of any storage that was allocated.
- */
-{
- char *t;
- if (*s == '-') {
- *b = t = testalloc(strlen(s) + 3);
- VOID sprintf(t, ".%c%s", SLASH, s);
- return t;
- } else {
- *b = 0;
- return s;
- }
-}
-
- int
-merge(tostdout, edarg, label, argv)
- int tostdout;
- char const *edarg;
- char const *const label[3];
- char const *const argv[3];
-/*
- * Do `merge [-p] EDARG -L l0 -L l1 -L l2 a0 a1 a2',
- * where TOSTDOUT specifies whether -p is present,
- * EDARG gives the editing type (e.g. "-A", or null for the default),
- * LABEL gives l0, l1 and l2, and ARGV gives a0, a1 and a2.
- * Yield DIFF_SUCCESS or DIFF_FAILURE.
- */
-{
- register int i;
- FILE *f;
- RILE *rt;
- char const *a[3], *t;
- char *b[3];
- int s;
-#if !DIFF3_BIN
- char const *d[2];
-#endif
-
- for (i=3; 0<=--i; )
- a[i] = normalize_arg(argv[i], &b[i]);
-
- if (!edarg)
- edarg = "-E";
-
-#if DIFF3_BIN
- t = 0;
- if (!tostdout)
- t = maketemp(0);
- s = run(
- -1, t,
- DIFF3, edarg, "-am",
- "-L", label[0],
- "-L", label[1],
- "-L", label[2],
- a[0], a[1], a[2], (char*)0
- );
- switch (s) {
- case DIFF_SUCCESS:
- break;
- case DIFF_FAILURE:
- warn("conflicts during merge");
- break;
- default:
- exiterr();
- }
- if (t) {
- if (!(f = fopenSafer(argv[0], "w")))
- efaterror(argv[0]);
- if (!(rt = Iopen(t, "r", (struct stat*)0)))
- efaterror(t);
- fastcopy(rt, f);
- Ifclose(rt);
- Ofclose(f);
- }
-#else
- for (i=0; i<2; i++)
- switch (run(
- -1, d[i]=maketemp(i),
- DIFF, a[i], a[2], (char*)0
- )) {
- case DIFF_FAILURE: case DIFF_SUCCESS: break;
- default: faterror("diff failed");
- }
- t = maketemp(2);
- s = run(
- -1, t,
- DIFF3, edarg, d[0], d[1], a[0], a[1], a[2],
- label[0], label[2], (char*)0
- );
- if (s != DIFF_SUCCESS) {
- s = DIFF_FAILURE;
- warn("overlaps or other problems during merge");
- }
- if (!(f = fopenSafer(t, "a+")))
- efaterror(t);
- aputs(tostdout ? "1,$p\n" : "w\n", f);
- Orewind(f);
- aflush(f);
- if (run(fileno(f), (char*)0, ED, "-", a[0], (char*)0))
- exiterr();
- Ofclose(f);
-#endif
-
- tempunlink();
- for (i=3; 0<=--i; )
- if (b[i])
- tfree(b[i]);
- return s;
-}
diff --git a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/partime.c b/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/partime.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 05b0108..0000000
--- a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/partime.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,701 +0,0 @@
-/* Parse a string, yielding a struct partime that describes it. */
-
-/* Copyright 1993, 1994, 1995 Paul Eggert
- Distributed under license by the Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-
-This file is part of RCS.
-
-RCS is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
-it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
-any later version.
-
-RCS is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
-GNU General Public License for more details.
-
-You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-along with RCS; see the file COPYING.
-If not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
-59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
-
-Report problems and direct all questions to:
-
- rcs-bugs@cs.purdue.edu
-
-*/
-
-#if has_conf_h
-# include "conf.h"
-#else
-# ifdef __STDC__
-# define P(x) x
-# else
-# define const
-# define P(x) ()
-# endif
-# include <limits.h>
-# include <time.h>
-#endif
-
-#include <ctype.h>
-#undef isdigit
-#define isdigit(c) (((unsigned)(c)-'0') <= 9) /* faster than stock */
-
-#include "partime.h"
-
-char const partimeId[]
- = "$FreeBSD$";
-
-
-/* Lookup tables for names of months, weekdays, time zones. */
-
-#define NAME_LENGTH_MAXIMUM 4
-
-struct name_val {
- char name[NAME_LENGTH_MAXIMUM];
- int val;
-};
-
-
-static char const *parse_decimal P((char const*,int,int,int,int,int*,int*));
-static char const *parse_fixed P((char const*,int,int*));
-static char const *parse_pattern_letter P((char const*,int,struct partime*));
-static char const *parse_prefix P((char const*,struct partime*,int*));
-static char const *parse_ranged P((char const*,int,int,int,int*));
-static int lookup P((char const*,struct name_val const[]));
-static int merge_partime P((struct partime*, struct partime const*));
-static void undefine P((struct partime*));
-
-
-static struct name_val const month_names[] = {
- {"jan",0}, {"feb",1}, {"mar",2}, {"apr",3}, {"may",4}, {"jun",5},
- {"jul",6}, {"aug",7}, {"sep",8}, {"oct",9}, {"nov",10}, {"dec",11},
- {"", TM_UNDEFINED}
-};
-
-static struct name_val const weekday_names[] = {
- {"sun",0}, {"mon",1}, {"tue",2}, {"wed",3}, {"thu",4}, {"fri",5}, {"sat",6},
- {"", TM_UNDEFINED}
-};
-
-#define hr60nonnegative(t) ((t)/100 * 60 + (t)%100)
-#define hr60(t) ((t)<0 ? -hr60nonnegative(-(t)) : hr60nonnegative(t))
-#define zs(t,s) {s, hr60(t)}
-#define zd(t,s,d) zs(t, s), zs((t)+100, d)
-
-static struct name_val const zone_names[] = {
- zs(-1000, "hst"), /* Hawaii */
- zd(-1000,"hast","hadt"),/* Hawaii-Aleutian */
- zd(- 900,"akst","akdt"),/* Alaska */
- zd(- 800, "pst", "pdt"),/* Pacific */
- zd(- 700, "mst", "mdt"),/* Mountain */
- zd(- 600, "cst", "cdt"),/* Central */
- zd(- 500, "est", "edt"),/* Eastern */
- zd(- 400, "ast", "adt"),/* Atlantic */
- zd(- 330, "nst", "ndt"),/* Newfoundland */
- zs( 000, "utc"), /* Coordinated Universal */
- zs( 000, "cut"), /* " */
- zs( 000, "ut"), /* Universal */
- zs( 000, "z"), /* Zulu (required by ISO 8601) */
- zd( 000, "gmt", "bst"),/* Greenwich Mean, British Summer */
- zs( 000, "wet"), /* Western Europe */
- zs( 100, "met"), /* Middle Europe */
- zs( 100, "cet"), /* Central Europe */
- zs( 200, "eet"), /* Eastern Europe */
- zs( 530, "ist"), /* India */
- zd( 900, "jst", "jdt"),/* Japan */
- zd( 900, "kst", "kdt"),/* Korea */
- zd( 1200,"nzst","nzdt"),/* New Zealand */
- { "lt", 1 },
-#if 0
- /* The following names are duplicates or are not well attested. */
- zs(-1100, "sst"), /* Samoa */
- zs(-1000, "tht"), /* Tahiti */
- zs(- 930, "mqt"), /* Marquesas */
- zs(- 900, "gbt"), /* Gambier */
- zd(- 900, "yst", "ydt"),/* Yukon - name is no longer used */
- zs(- 830, "pit"), /* Pitcairn */
- zd(- 500, "cst", "cdt"),/* Cuba */
- zd(- 500, "ast", "adt"),/* Acre */
- zd(- 400, "wst", "wdt"),/* Western Brazil */
- zd(- 400, "ast", "adt"),/* Andes */
- zd(- 400, "cst", "cdt"),/* Chile */
- zs(- 300, "wgt"), /* Western Greenland */
- zd(- 300, "est", "edt"),/* Eastern South America */
- zs(- 300, "mgt"), /* Middle Greenland */
- zd(- 200, "fst", "fdt"),/* Fernando de Noronha */
- zs(- 100, "egt"), /* Eastern Greenland */
- zs(- 100, "aat"), /* Atlantic Africa */
- zs(- 100, "act"), /* Azores and Canaries */
- zs( 000, "wat"), /* West Africa */
- zs( 100, "cat"), /* Central Africa */
- zd( 100, "mez","mesz"),/* Mittel-Europaeische Zeit */
- zs( 200, "sat"), /* South Africa */
- zd( 200, "ist", "idt"),/* Israel */
- zs( 300, "eat"), /* East Africa */
- zd( 300, "ast", "adt"),/* Arabia */
- zd( 300, "msk", "msd"),/* Moscow */
- zd( 330, "ist", "idt"),/* Iran */
- zs( 400, "gst"), /* Gulf */
- zs( 400, "smt"), /* Seychelles & Mascarene */
- zd( 400, "esk", "esd"),/* Yekaterinburg */
- zd( 400, "bsk", "bsd"),/* Baku */
- zs( 430, "aft"), /* Afghanistan */
- zd( 500, "osk", "osd"),/* Omsk */
- zs( 500, "pkt"), /* Pakistan */
- zd( 500, "tsk", "tsd"),/* Tashkent */
- zs( 545, "npt"), /* Nepal */
- zs( 600, "bgt"), /* Bangladesh */
- zd( 600, "nsk", "nsd"),/* Novosibirsk */
- zs( 630, "bmt"), /* Burma */
- zs( 630, "cct"), /* Cocos */
- zs( 700, "ict"), /* Indochina */
- zs( 700, "jvt"), /* Java */
- zd( 700, "isk", "isd"),/* Irkutsk */
- zs( 800, "hkt"), /* Hong Kong */
- zs( 800, "pst"), /* Philippines */
- zs( 800, "sgt"), /* Singapore */
- zd( 800, "cst", "cdt"),/* China */
- zd( 800, "ust", "udt"),/* Ulan Bator */
- zd( 800, "wst", "wst"),/* Western Australia */
- zd( 800, "ysk", "ysd"),/* Yakutsk */
- zs( 900, "blt"), /* Belau */
- zs( 900, "mlt"), /* Moluccas */
- zd( 900, "vsk", "vsd"),/* Vladivostok */
- zd( 930, "cst", "cst"),/* Central Australia */
- zs( 1000, "gst"), /* Guam */
- zd( 1000, "gsk", "gsd"),/* Magadan */
- zd( 1000, "est", "est"),/* Eastern Australia */
- zd( 1100,"lhst","lhst"),/* Lord Howe */
- zd( 1100, "psk", "psd"),/* Petropavlovsk-Kamchatski */
- zs( 1100,"ncst"), /* New Caledonia */
- zs( 1130,"nrft"), /* Norfolk */
- zd( 1200, "ask", "asd"),/* Anadyr */
- zs( 1245,"nz-chat"), /* Chatham */
- zs( 1300, "tgt"), /* Tongatapu */
-#endif
- {"", -1}
-};
-
- static int
-lookup (s, table)
- char const *s;
- struct name_val const table[];
-/* Look for a prefix of S in TABLE, returning val for first matching entry. */
-{
- int j;
- char buf[NAME_LENGTH_MAXIMUM];
-
- for (j = 0; j < NAME_LENGTH_MAXIMUM; j++) {
- unsigned char c = *s++;
- buf[j] = isupper (c) ? tolower (c) : c;
- if (!isalpha (c))
- break;
- }
- for (; table[0].name[0]; table++)
- for (j = 0; buf[j] == table[0].name[j]; )
- if (++j == NAME_LENGTH_MAXIMUM || !table[0].name[j])
- goto done;
- done:
- return table[0].val;
-}
-
-
- static void
-undefine (t) struct partime *t;
-/* Set *T to ``undefined'' values. */
-{
- t->tm.tm_sec = t->tm.tm_min = t->tm.tm_hour = t->tm.tm_mday = t->tm.tm_mon
- = t->tm.tm_year = t->tm.tm_wday = t->tm.tm_yday
- = t->ymodulus = t->yweek
- = TM_UNDEFINED;
- t->zone = TM_UNDEFINED_ZONE;
-}
-
-/*
-* Array of patterns to look for in a date string.
-* Order is important: we look for the first matching pattern
-* whose values do not contradict values that we already know about.
-* See `parse_pattern_letter' below for the meaning of the pattern codes.
-*/
-static char const * const patterns[] = {
- /*
- * These traditional patterns must come first,
- * to prevent an ISO 8601 format from misinterpreting their prefixes.
- */
- "E_n_y", "x", /* RFC 822 */
- "E_n", "n_E", "n", "t:m:s_A", "t:m_A", "t_A", /* traditional */
- "y/N/D$", /* traditional RCS */
-
- /* ISO 8601:1988 formats, generalized a bit. */
- "y-N-D$", "4ND$", "Y-N$",
- "RND$", "-R=N$", "-R$", "--N=D$", "N=DT",
- "--N$", "---D$", "DT",
- "Y-d$", "4d$", "R=d$", "-d$", "dT",
- "y-W-X", "yWX", "y=W",
- "-r-W-X", "r-W-XT", "-rWX", "rWXT", "-W=X", "W=XT", "-W",
- "-w-X", "w-XT", "---X$", "XT", "4$",
- "T",
- "h:m:s$", "hms$", "h:m$", "hm$", "h$", "-m:s$", "-ms$", "-m$", "--s$",
- "Y", "Z",
-
- 0
-};
-
- static char const *
-parse_prefix (str, t, pi) char const *str; struct partime *t; int *pi;
-/*
-* Parse an initial prefix of STR, setting *T accordingly.
-* Return the first character after the prefix, or 0 if it couldn't be parsed.
-* Start with pattern *PI; if success, set *PI to the next pattern to try.
-* Set *PI to -1 if we know there are no more patterns to try;
-* if *PI is initially negative, give up immediately.
-*/
-{
- int i = *pi;
- char const *pat;
- unsigned char c;
-
- if (i < 0)
- return 0;
-
- /* Remove initial noise. */
- while (!isalnum (c = *str) && c != '-' && c != '+') {
- if (!c) {
- undefine (t);
- *pi = -1;
- return str;
- }
- str++;
- }
-
- /* Try a pattern until one succeeds. */
- while ((pat = patterns[i++]) != 0) {
- char const *s = str;
- undefine (t);
- do {
- if (!(c = *pat++)) {
- *pi = i;
- return s;
- }
- } while ((s = parse_pattern_letter (s, c, t)) != 0);
- }
-
- return 0;
-}
-
- static char const *
-parse_fixed (s, digits, res) char const *s; int digits, *res;
-/*
-* Parse an initial prefix of S of length DIGITS; it must be a number.
-* Store the parsed number into *RES.
-* Return the first character after the prefix, or 0 if it couldn't be parsed.
-*/
-{
- int n = 0;
- char const *lim = s + digits;
- while (s < lim) {
- unsigned d = *s++ - '0';
- if (9 < d)
- return 0;
- n = 10*n + d;
- }
- *res = n;
- return s;
-}
-
- static char const *
-parse_ranged (s, digits, lo, hi, res) char const *s; int digits, lo, hi, *res;
-/*
-* Parse an initial prefix of S of length DIGITS;
-* it must be a number in the range LO through HI.
-* Store the parsed number into *RES.
-* Return the first character after the prefix, or 0 if it couldn't be parsed.
-*/
-{
- s = parse_fixed (s, digits, res);
- return s && lo<=*res && *res<=hi ? s : 0;
-}
-
- static char const *
-parse_decimal (s, digits, lo, hi, resolution, res, fres)
- char const *s;
- int digits, lo, hi, resolution, *res, *fres;
-/*
-* Parse an initial prefix of S of length DIGITS;
-* it must be a number in the range LO through HI
-* and it may be followed by a fraction that is to be computed using RESOLUTION.
-* Store the parsed number into *RES; store the fraction times RESOLUTION,
-* rounded to the nearest integer, into *FRES.
-* Return the first character after the prefix, or 0 if it couldn't be parsed.
-*/
-{
- s = parse_fixed (s, digits, res);
- if (s && lo<=*res && *res<=hi) {
- int f = 0;
- if ((s[0]==',' || s[0]=='.') && isdigit ((unsigned char) s[1])) {
- char const *s1 = ++s;
- int num10 = 0, denom10 = 10, product;
- while (isdigit ((unsigned char) *++s))
- denom10 *= 10;
- s = parse_fixed (s1, s - s1, &num10);
- product = num10*resolution;
- f = (product + (denom10>>1)) / denom10;
- f -= f & (product%denom10 == denom10>>1); /* round to even */
- if (f < 0 || product/resolution != num10)
- return 0; /* overflow */
- }
- *fres = f;
- return s;
- }
- return 0;
-}
-
- char *
-parzone (s, zone) char const *s; long *zone;
-/*
-* Parse an initial prefix of S; it must denote a time zone.
-* Set *ZONE to the number of seconds east of GMT,
-* or to TM_LOCAL_ZONE if it is the local time zone.
-* Return the first character after the prefix, or 0 if it couldn't be parsed.
-*/
-{
- char sign;
- int hh, mm, ss;
- int minutesEastOfUTC;
- long offset, z;
-
- /*
- * The formats are LT, n, n DST, nDST, no, o
- * where n is a time zone name
- * and o is a time zone offset of the form [-+]hh[:mm[:ss]].
- */
- switch (*s) {
- case '-': case '+':
- z = 0;
- break;
-
- default:
- minutesEastOfUTC = lookup (s, zone_names);
- if (minutesEastOfUTC == -1)
- return 0;
-
- /* Don't bother to check rest of spelling. */
- while (isalpha ((unsigned char) *s))
- s++;
-
- /* Don't modify LT. */
- if (minutesEastOfUTC == 1) {
- *zone = TM_LOCAL_ZONE;
- return (char *) s;
- }
-
- z = minutesEastOfUTC * 60L;
-
- /* Look for trailing " DST". */
- if (
- (s[-1]=='T' || s[-1]=='t') &&
- (s[-2]=='S' || s[-2]=='s') &&
- (s[-3]=='D' || s[-3]=='t')
- )
- goto trailing_dst;
- while (isspace ((unsigned char) *s))
- s++;
- if (
- (s[0]=='D' || s[0]=='d') &&
- (s[1]=='S' || s[1]=='s') &&
- (s[2]=='T' || s[2]=='t')
- ) {
- s += 3;
- trailing_dst:
- *zone = z + 60*60;
- return (char *) s;
- }
-
- switch (*s) {
- case '-': case '+': break;
- default: return (char *) s;
- }
- }
- sign = *s++;
-
- if (!(s = parse_ranged (s, 2, 0, 23, &hh)))
- return 0;
- mm = ss = 0;
- if (*s == ':')
- s++;
- if (isdigit ((unsigned char) *s)) {
- if (!(s = parse_ranged (s, 2, 0, 59, &mm)))
- return 0;
- if (*s==':' && s[-3]==':' && isdigit ((unsigned char) s[1])) {
- if (!(s = parse_ranged (s + 1, 2, 0, 59, &ss)))
- return 0;
- }
- }
- if (isdigit ((unsigned char) *s))
- return 0;
- offset = (hh*60 + mm)*60L + ss;
- *zone = z + (sign=='-' ? -offset : offset);
- /*
- * ?? Are fractions allowed here?
- * If so, they're not implemented.
- */
- return (char *) s;
-}
-
- static char const *
-parse_pattern_letter (s, c, t) char const *s; int c; struct partime *t;
-/*
-* Parse an initial prefix of S, matching the pattern whose code is C.
-* Set *T accordingly.
-* Return the first character after the prefix, or 0 if it couldn't be parsed.
-*/
-{
- switch (c) {
- case '$': /* The next character must be a non-digit. */
- if (isdigit ((unsigned char) *s))
- return 0;
- break;
-
- case '-': case '/': case ':':
- /* These characters stand for themselves. */
- if (*s++ != c)
- return 0;
- break;
-
- case '4': /* 4-digit year */
- s = parse_fixed (s, 4, &t->tm.tm_year);
- break;
-
- case '=': /* optional '-' */
- s += *s == '-';
- break;
-
- case 'A': /* AM or PM */
- /*
- * This matches the regular expression [AaPp][Mm]?.
- * It must not be followed by a letter or digit;
- * otherwise it would match prefixes of strings like "PST".
- */
- switch (*s++) {
- case 'A': case 'a':
- if (t->tm.tm_hour == 12)
- t->tm.tm_hour = 0;
- break;
-
- case 'P': case 'p':
- if (t->tm.tm_hour != 12)
- t->tm.tm_hour += 12;
- break;
-
- default: return 0;
- }
- switch (*s) {
- case 'M': case 'm': s++; break;
- }
- if (isalnum (*s))
- return 0;
- break;
-
- case 'D': /* day of month [01-31] */
- s = parse_ranged (s, 2, 1, 31, &t->tm.tm_mday);
- break;
-
- case 'd': /* day of year [001-366] */
- s = parse_ranged (s, 3, 1, 366, &t->tm.tm_yday);
- t->tm.tm_yday--;
- break;
-
- case 'E': /* extended day of month [1-9, 01-31] */
- s = parse_ranged (s, (
- isdigit ((unsigned char) s[0]) &&
- isdigit ((unsigned char) s[1])
- ) + 1, 1, 31, &t->tm.tm_mday);
- break;
-
- case 'h': /* hour [00-23 followed by optional fraction] */
- {
- int frac;
- s = parse_decimal (s, 2, 0, 23, 60*60, &t->tm.tm_hour, &frac);
- t->tm.tm_min = frac / 60;
- t->tm.tm_sec = frac % 60;
- }
- break;
-
- case 'm': /* minute [00-59 followed by optional fraction] */
- s = parse_decimal (s, 2, 0, 59, 60, &t->tm.tm_min, &t->tm.tm_sec);
- break;
-
- case 'n': /* month name [e.g. "Jan"] */
- if (!TM_DEFINED (t->tm.tm_mon = lookup (s, month_names)))
- return 0;
- /* Don't bother to check rest of spelling. */
- while (isalpha ((unsigned char) *s))
- s++;
- break;
-
- case 'N': /* month [01-12] */
- s = parse_ranged (s, 2, 1, 12, &t->tm.tm_mon);
- t->tm.tm_mon--;
- break;
-
- case 'r': /* year % 10 (remainder in origin-0 decade) [0-9] */
- s = parse_fixed (s, 1, &t->tm.tm_year);
- t->ymodulus = 10;
- break;
-
- case_R:
- case 'R': /* year % 100 (remainder in origin-0 century) [00-99] */
- s = parse_fixed (s, 2, &t->tm.tm_year);
- t->ymodulus = 100;
- break;
-
- case 's': /* second [00-60 followed by optional fraction] */
- {
- int frac;
- s = parse_decimal (s, 2, 0, 60, 1, &t->tm.tm_sec, &frac);
- t->tm.tm_sec += frac;
- }
- break;
-
- case 'T': /* 'T' or 't' */
- switch (*s++) {
- case 'T': case 't': break;
- default: return 0;
- }
- break;
-
- case 't': /* traditional hour [1-9 or 01-12] */
- s = parse_ranged (s, (
- isdigit ((unsigned char) s[0]) && isdigit ((unsigned char) s[1])
- ) + 1, 1, 12, &t->tm.tm_hour);
- break;
-
- case 'w': /* 'W' or 'w' only (stands for current week) */
- switch (*s++) {
- case 'W': case 'w': break;
- default: return 0;
- }
- break;
-
- case 'W': /* 'W' or 'w', followed by a week of year [00-53] */
- switch (*s++) {
- case 'W': case 'w': break;
- default: return 0;
- }
- s = parse_ranged (s, 2, 0, 53, &t->yweek);
- break;
-
- case 'X': /* weekday (1=Mon ... 7=Sun) [1-7] */
- s = parse_ranged (s, 1, 1, 7, &t->tm.tm_wday);
- t->tm.tm_wday--;
- break;
-
- case 'x': /* weekday name [e.g. "Sun"] */
- if (!TM_DEFINED (t->tm.tm_wday = lookup (s, weekday_names)))
- return 0;
- /* Don't bother to check rest of spelling. */
- while (isalpha ((unsigned char) *s))
- s++;
- break;
-
- case 'y': /* either R or Y */
- if (
- isdigit ((unsigned char) s[0]) &&
- isdigit ((unsigned char) s[1]) &&
- !isdigit ((unsigned char) s[2])
- )
- goto case_R;
- /* fall into */
- case 'Y': /* year in full [4 or more digits] */
- {
- int len = 0;
- while (isdigit ((unsigned char) s[len]))
- len++;
- if (len < 4)
- return 0;
- s = parse_fixed (s, len, &t->tm.tm_year);
- }
- break;
-
- case 'Z': /* time zone */
- s = parzone (s, &t->zone);
- break;
-
- case '_': /* possibly empty sequence of non-alphanumerics */
- while (!isalnum (*s) && *s)
- s++;
- break;
-
- default: /* bad pattern */
- return 0;
- }
- return s;
-}
-
- static int
-merge_partime (t, u) struct partime *t; struct partime const *u;
-/*
-* If there is no conflict, merge into *T the additional information in *U
-* and return 0. Otherwise do nothing and return -1.
-*/
-{
-# define conflict(a,b) ((a) != (b) && TM_DEFINED (a) && TM_DEFINED (b))
- if (
- conflict (t->tm.tm_sec, u->tm.tm_sec) ||
- conflict (t->tm.tm_min, u->tm.tm_min) ||
- conflict (t->tm.tm_hour, u->tm.tm_hour) ||
- conflict (t->tm.tm_mday, u->tm.tm_mday) ||
- conflict (t->tm.tm_mon, u->tm.tm_mon) ||
- conflict (t->tm.tm_year, u->tm.tm_year) ||
- conflict (t->tm.tm_wday, u->tm.tm_yday) ||
- conflict (t->ymodulus, u->ymodulus) ||
- conflict (t->yweek, u->yweek) ||
- (
- t->zone != u->zone &&
- t->zone != TM_UNDEFINED_ZONE &&
- u->zone != TM_UNDEFINED_ZONE
- )
- )
- return -1;
-# undef conflict
-# define merge_(a,b) if (TM_DEFINED (b)) (a) = (b);
- merge_ (t->tm.tm_sec, u->tm.tm_sec)
- merge_ (t->tm.tm_min, u->tm.tm_min)
- merge_ (t->tm.tm_hour, u->tm.tm_hour)
- merge_ (t->tm.tm_mday, u->tm.tm_mday)
- merge_ (t->tm.tm_mon, u->tm.tm_mon)
- merge_ (t->tm.tm_year, u->tm.tm_year)
- merge_ (t->tm.tm_wday, u->tm.tm_yday)
- merge_ (t->ymodulus, u->ymodulus)
- merge_ (t->yweek, u->yweek)
-# undef merge_
- if (u->zone != TM_UNDEFINED_ZONE) t->zone = u->zone;
- return 0;
-}
-
- char *
-partime (s, t) char const *s; struct partime *t;
-/*
-* Parse a date/time prefix of S, putting the parsed result into *T.
-* Return the first character after the prefix.
-* The prefix may contain no useful information;
-* in that case, *T will contain only undefined values.
-*/
-{
- struct partime p;
-
- undefine (t);
- while (*s) {
- int i = 0;
- char const *s1;
- do {
- if (!(s1 = parse_prefix (s, &p, &i)))
- return (char *) s;
- } while (merge_partime (t, &p) != 0);
- s = s1;
- }
- return (char *) s;
-}
diff --git a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/partime.h b/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/partime.h
deleted file mode 100644
index 5d3983f..0000000
--- a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/partime.h
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,71 +0,0 @@
-/* Parse a string, yielding a struct partime that describes it. */
-
-/* Copyright 1993, 1994, 1995 Paul Eggert
- Distributed under license by the Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-
-This file is part of RCS.
-
-RCS is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
-it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
-any later version.
-
-RCS is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
-GNU General Public License for more details.
-
-You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-along with RCS; see the file COPYING.
-If not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
-59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
-
-Report problems and direct all questions to:
-
- rcs-bugs@cs.purdue.edu
-
-*/
-
-#define TM_UNDEFINED (-1)
-#define TM_DEFINED(x) (0 <= (x))
-
-#define TM_UNDEFINED_ZONE ((long) -24 * 60 * 60)
-#define TM_LOCAL_ZONE (TM_UNDEFINED_ZONE - 1)
-
-struct partime {
- /*
- * This structure describes the parsed time.
- * Only the following tm_* values in it are used:
- * sec, min, hour, mday, mon, year, wday, yday.
- * If TM_UNDEFINED(value), the parser never found the value.
- * The tm_year field is the actual year, not the year - 1900;
- * but see ymodulus below.
- */
- struct tm tm;
-
- /*
- * If !TM_UNDEFINED(ymodulus),
- * then tm.tm_year is actually modulo ymodulus.
- */
- int ymodulus;
-
- /*
- * Week of year, ISO 8601 style.
- * If TM_UNDEFINED(yweek), the parser never found yweek.
- * Weeks start on Mondays.
- * Week 1 includes Jan 4.
- */
- int yweek;
-
- /* Seconds east of UTC; or TM_LOCAL_ZONE or TM_UNDEFINED_ZONE. */
- long zone;
-};
-
-#if defined(__STDC__) || has_prototypes
-# define __PARTIME_P(x) x
-#else
-# define __PARTIME_P(x) ()
-#endif
-
-char *partime __PARTIME_P((char const *, struct partime *));
-char *parzone __PARTIME_P((char const *, long *));
diff --git a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsbase.h b/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsbase.h
deleted file mode 100644
index 9f2f68c..0000000
--- a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsbase.h
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,762 +0,0 @@
-/* RCS common definitions and data structures */
-
-#define RCSBASE "$FreeBSD$"
-
-/* Copyright 1982, 1988, 1989 Walter Tichy
- Copyright 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995 Paul Eggert
- Distributed under license by the Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-
-This file is part of RCS.
-
-RCS is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
-it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
-any later version.
-
-RCS is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
-GNU General Public License for more details.
-
-You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-along with RCS; see the file COPYING.
-If not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
-59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
-
-Report problems and direct all questions to:
-
- rcs-bugs@cs.purdue.edu
-
-*/
-
-/*
- * Revision 5.20 1995/06/16 06:19:24 eggert
- * Update FSF address.
- *
- * Revision 5.19 1995/06/01 16:23:43 eggert
- * (SIZEABLE_PATH): Don't depend on PATH_MAX: it's not worth configuring.
- * (Ioffset_type,BINARY_EXPAND,MIN_UNEXPAND,MIN_UNCHANGED_EXPAND): New macros.
- * (maps_memory): New macro; replaces many instances of `has_mmap'.
- * (cacheptr): Renamed from cachetell.
- * (struct RILE): New alternate name for RILE; the type is now recursive.
- * (deallocate): New member for RILE, used for generic buffer deallocation.
- * (cacheunget_): No longer take a failure arg; just call Ierror on failure.
- * (struct rcslock): Renamed from struct lock, to avoid collisions with
- * system headers on some hosts. All users changed.
- * (basefilename): Renamed from basename, likewise.
- * (dirtpname): Remove; no longer external.
- * (dirlen, dateform): Remove; no longer used.
- * (cmpdate, fopenSafer, fdSafer, readAccessFilenameBuffer): New functions.
- * (zonelenmax): Increase to 9 for full ISO 8601 format.
- * (catchmmapints): Depend on has_NFS.
- *
- * Revision 5.18 1994/03/17 14:05:48 eggert
- * Add primitives for reading backwards from a RILE;
- * this is needed to go back and find the $Log prefix.
- * Specify subprocess input via file descriptor, not file name. Remove lint.
- *
- * Revision 5.17 1993/11/09 17:40:15 eggert
- * Move RCS-specific time handling into rcstime.c.
- * printf_string now takes two arguments, alas.
- *
- * Revision 5.16 1993/11/03 17:42:27 eggert
- * Don't arbitrarily limit the number of joins. Remove `nil'.
- * Add Name keyword. Don't discard ignored phrases.
- * Add support for merge -A vs -E, and allow up to three labels.
- * Improve quality of diagnostics and prototypes.
- *
- * Revision 5.15 1992/07/28 16:12:44 eggert
- * Statement macro names now end in _.
- *
- * Revision 5.14 1992/02/17 23:02:22 eggert
- * Add -T support. Work around NFS mmap SIGBUS problem.
- *
- * Revision 5.13 1992/01/24 18:44:19 eggert
- * Add support for bad_creat0. lint -> RCS_lint
- *
- * Revision 5.12 1992/01/06 02:42:34 eggert
- * while (E) ; -> while (E) continue;
- *
- * Revision 5.11 1991/10/07 17:32:46 eggert
- * Support piece tables even if !has_mmap.
- *
- * Revision 5.10 1991/09/24 00:28:39 eggert
- * Remove unexported functions.
- *
- * Revision 5.9 1991/08/19 03:13:55 eggert
- * Add piece tables and other tuneups, and NFS workarounds.
- *
- * Revision 5.8 1991/04/21 11:58:20 eggert
- * Add -x, RCSINIT, MS-DOS support.
- *
- * Revision 5.7 1991/02/28 19:18:50 eggert
- * Try setuid() if seteuid() doesn't work.
- *
- * Revision 5.6 1991/02/26 17:48:37 eggert
- * Support new link behavior. Move ANSI C / Posix declarations into conf.sh.
- *
- * Revision 5.5 1990/12/04 05:18:43 eggert
- * Use -I for prompts and -q for diagnostics.
- *
- * Revision 5.4 1990/11/01 05:03:35 eggert
- * Don't assume that builtins are functions; they may be macros.
- * Permit arbitrary data in logs.
- *
- * Revision 5.3 1990/09/26 23:36:58 eggert
- * Port wait() to non-Posix ANSI C hosts.
- *
- * Revision 5.2 1990/09/04 08:02:20 eggert
- * Don't redefine NAME_MAX, PATH_MAX.
- * Improve incomplete line handling. Standardize yes-or-no procedure.
- *
- * Revision 5.1 1990/08/29 07:13:53 eggert
- * Add -kkvl. Fix type typos exposed by porting. Clean old log messages too.
- *
- * Revision 5.0 1990/08/22 08:12:44 eggert
- * Adjust ANSI C / Posix support. Add -k, -V, setuid. Don't call access().
- * Remove compile-time limits; use malloc instead.
- * Ansify and Posixate. Add support for ISO 8859.
- * Remove snoop and v2 support.
- *
- * Revision 4.9 89/05/01 15:17:14 narten
- * botched previous USG fix
- *
- * Revision 4.8 89/05/01 14:53:05 narten
- * changed #include <strings.h> -> string.h for USG systems.
- *
- * Revision 4.7 88/11/08 15:58:45 narten
- * removed defs for functions loaded from libraries
- *
- * Revision 4.6 88/08/09 19:12:36 eggert
- * Shrink stdio code size; remove lint; permit -Dhshsize=nn.
- *
- * Revision 4.5 87/12/18 17:06:41 narten
- * made removed BSD ifdef, now uses V4_2BSD
- *
- * Revision 4.4 87/10/18 10:29:49 narten
- * Updating version numbers
- * Changes relative to 1.1 are actually relative to 4.2
- *
- * Revision 1.3 87/09/24 14:02:25 narten
- * changes for lint
- *
- * Revision 1.2 87/03/27 14:22:02 jenkins
- * Port to suns
- *
- * Revision 4.2 83/12/20 16:04:20 wft
- * merged 3.6.1.1 and 4.1 (SMALLOG, logsize).
- * moved setting of STRICT_LOCKING to Makefile.
- * changed DOLLAR to UNKN (conflict with KDELIM).
- *
- * Revision 4.1 83/05/04 09:12:41 wft
- * Added markers Id and RCSfile.
- * Added Dbranch for default branches.
- *
- * Revision 3.6.1.1 83/12/02 21:56:22 wft
- * Increased logsize, added macro SMALLOG.
- *
- * Revision 3.6 83/01/15 16:43:28 wft
- * 4.2 prerelease
- *
- * Revision 3.6 83/01/15 16:43:28 wft
- * Replaced dbm.h with BYTESIZ, fixed definition of rindex().
- * Added variants of NCPFN and NCPPN for bsd 4.2, selected by defining V4_2BSD.
- * Added macro DELNUMFORM to have uniform format for printing delta text nodes.
- * Added macro DELETE to mark deleted deltas.
- *
- * Revision 3.5 82/12/10 12:16:56 wft
- * Added two forms of DATEFORM, one using %02d, the other %.2d.
- *
- * Revision 3.4 82/12/04 20:01:25 wft
- * added LOCKER, Locker, and USG (redefinition of rindex).
- *
- * Revision 3.3 82/12/03 12:22:04 wft
- * Added dbm.h, stdio.h, RCSBASE, RCSSEP, RCSSUF, WORKMODE, TMPFILE3,
- * PRINTDATE, PRINTTIME, map, and ctab; removed Suffix. Redefined keyvallength
- * using NCPPN. Changed putc() to abort on write error.
- *
- * Revision 3.2 82/10/18 15:03:52 wft
- * added macro STRICT_LOCKING, removed RCSUMASK.
- * renamed JOINFILE[1,2] to JOINFIL[1,2].
- *
- * Revision 3.1 82/10/11 19:41:17 wft
- * removed NBPW, NBPC, NCPW.
- * added typdef int void to aid compiling
- */
-
-
-#include "conf.h"
-
-
-#define EXIT_TROUBLE DIFF_TROUBLE
-
-#ifdef _POSIX_PATH_MAX
-# define SIZEABLE_PATH _POSIX_PATH_MAX
-#else
-# define SIZEABLE_PATH 255 /* size of a large path; not a hard limit */
-#endif
-
-/* for traditional C hosts with unusual size arguments */
-#define Fread(p,s,n,f) fread(p, (freadarg_type)(s), (freadarg_type)(n), f)
-#define Fwrite(p,s,n,f) fwrite(p, (freadarg_type)(s), (freadarg_type)(n), f)
-
-
-/*
- * Parameters
- */
-
-/* backwards compatibility with old versions of RCS */
-#define VERSION_min 3 /* old output RCS format supported */
-#define VERSION_max 5 /* newest output RCS format supported */
-#ifndef VERSION_DEFAULT /* default RCS output format */
-# define VERSION_DEFAULT VERSION_max
-#endif
-#define VERSION(n) ((n) - VERSION_DEFAULT) /* internally, 0 is the default */
-
-#ifndef STRICT_LOCKING
-#define STRICT_LOCKING 1
-#endif
- /* 0 sets the default locking to non-strict; */
- /* used in experimental environments. */
- /* 1 sets the default locking to strict; */
- /* used in production environments. */
-
-#define yearlength 16 /* (good through AD 9,999,999,999,999,999) */
-#define datesize (yearlength+16) /* size of output of time2date */
-#define RCSTMPPREFIX '_' /* prefix for temp files in working dir */
-#define KDELIM '$' /* delimiter for keywords */
-#define VDELIM ':' /* separates keywords from values */
-#define DEFAULTSTATE "Exp" /* default state of revisions */
-
-
-
-#define true 1
-#define false 0
-
-
-/*
- * RILE - readonly file
- * declarecache; - declares local cache for RILE variable(s)
- * setupcache - sets up the local RILE cache, but does not initialize it
- * cache, uncache - caches and uncaches the local RILE;
- * (uncache,cache) is needed around functions that advance the RILE pointer
- * Igeteof_(f,c,s) - get a char c from f, executing statement s at EOF
- * cachegeteof_(c,s) - Igeteof_ applied to the local RILE
- * Iget_(f,c) - like Igeteof_, except EOF is an error
- * cacheget_(c) - Iget_ applied to the local RILE
- * cacheunget_(f,c,s) - read c backwards from cached f, executing s at BOF
- * Ifileno, Ioffset_type, Irewind, Itell - analogs to stdio routines
- *
- * By conventions, macros whose names end in _ are statements, not expressions.
- * Following such macros with `; else' results in a syntax error.
- */
-
-#define maps_memory (has_map_fd || has_mmap)
-
-#if large_memory
- typedef unsigned char const *Iptr_type;
- typedef struct RILE {
- Iptr_type ptr, lim;
- unsigned char *base; /* not Iptr_type for lint's sake */
- unsigned char *readlim;
- int fd;
-# if maps_memory
- void (*deallocate) P((struct RILE *));
-# else
- FILE *stream;
-# endif
- } RILE;
-# if maps_memory
-# define declarecache register Iptr_type ptr, lim
-# define setupcache(f) (lim = (f)->lim)
-# define Igeteof_(f,c,s) if ((f)->ptr==(f)->lim) s else (c)= *(f)->ptr++;
-# define cachegeteof_(c,s) if (ptr==lim) s else (c)= *ptr++;
-# else
- int Igetmore P((RILE*));
-# define declarecache register Iptr_type ptr; register RILE *rRILE
-# define setupcache(f) (rRILE = (f))
-# define Igeteof_(f,c,s) if ((f)->ptr==(f)->readlim && !Igetmore(f)) s else (c)= *(f)->ptr++;
-# define cachegeteof_(c,s) if (ptr==rRILE->readlim && !Igetmore(rRILE)) s else (c)= *ptr++;
-# endif
-# define uncache(f) ((f)->ptr = ptr)
-# define cache(f) (ptr = (f)->ptr)
-# define Iget_(f,c) Igeteof_(f,c,Ieof();)
-# define cacheget_(c) cachegeteof_(c,Ieof();)
-# define cacheunget_(f,c) (c)=(--ptr)[-1];
-# define Ioffset_type size_t
-# define Itell(f) ((f)->ptr - (f)->base)
-# define Irewind(f) ((f)->ptr = (f)->base)
-# define cacheptr() ptr
-# define Ifileno(f) ((f)->fd)
-#else
-# define RILE FILE
-# define declarecache register FILE *ptr
-# define setupcache(f) (ptr = (f))
-# define uncache(f)
-# define cache(f)
-# define Igeteof_(f,c,s) {if(((c)=getc(f))==EOF){testIerror(f);if(feof(f))s}}
-# define cachegeteof_(c,s) Igeteof_(ptr,c,s)
-# define Iget_(f,c) { if (((c)=getc(f))==EOF) testIeof(f); }
-# define cacheget_(c) Iget_(ptr,c)
-# define cacheunget_(f,c) if(fseek(ptr,-2L,SEEK_CUR))Ierror();else cacheget_(c)
-# define Ioffset_type long
-# define Itell(f) ftell(f)
-# define Ifileno(f) fileno(f)
-#endif
-
-/* Print a char, but abort on write error. */
-#define aputc_(c,o) { if (putc(c,o)==EOF) testOerror(o); }
-
-/* Get a character from an RCS file, perhaps copying to a new RCS file. */
-#define GETCeof_(o,c,s) { cachegeteof_(c,s) if (o) aputc_(c,o) }
-#define GETC_(o,c) { cacheget_(c) if (o) aputc_(c,o) }
-
-
-#define WORKMODE(RCSmode, writable) (((RCSmode)&(mode_t)~(S_IWUSR|S_IWGRP|S_IWOTH)) | ((writable)?S_IWUSR:0))
-/* computes mode of working file: same as RCSmode, but write permission */
-/* determined by writable */
-
-
-/* character classes and token codes */
-enum tokens {
-/* classes */ DELIM, DIGIT, IDCHAR, NEWLN, LETTER, Letter,
- PERIOD, SBEGIN, SPACE, UNKN,
-/* tokens */ COLON, ID, NUM, SEMI, STRING
-};
-
-#define SDELIM '@' /* the actual character is needed for string handling*/
-/* SDELIM must be consistent with ctab[], so that ctab[SDELIM]==SBEGIN.
- * there should be no overlap among SDELIM, KDELIM, and VDELIM
- */
-
-#define isdigit(c) (((unsigned)(c)-'0') <= 9) /* faster than ctab[c]==DIGIT */
-
-
-
-
-
-/***************************************
- * Data structures for the symbol table
- ***************************************/
-
-/* Buffer of arbitrary data */
-struct buf {
- char *string;
- size_t size;
-};
-struct cbuf {
- char const *string;
- size_t size;
-};
-
-/* Hash table entry */
-struct hshentry {
- char const * num; /* pointer to revision number (ASCIZ) */
- char const * date; /* pointer to date of checkin */
- char const * author; /* login of person checking in */
- char const * lockedby; /* who locks the revision */
- char const * state; /* state of revision (Exp by default) */
- char const * name; /* name (if any) by which retrieved */
- struct cbuf log; /* log message requested at checkin */
- struct branchhead * branches; /* list of first revisions on branches*/
- struct cbuf ig; /* ignored phrases in admin part */
- struct cbuf igtext; /* ignored phrases in deltatext part */
- struct hshentry * next; /* next revision on same branch */
- struct hshentry * nexthsh; /* next revision with same hash value */
- long insertlns;/* lines inserted (computed by rlog) */
- long deletelns;/* lines deleted (computed by rlog) */
- char selector; /* true if selected, false if deleted */
-};
-
-/* list of hash entries */
-struct hshentries {
- struct hshentries *rest;
- struct hshentry *first;
-};
-
-/* list element for branch lists */
-struct branchhead {
- struct hshentry * hsh;
- struct branchhead * nextbranch;
-};
-
-/* accesslist element */
-struct access {
- char const * login;
- struct access * nextaccess;
-};
-
-/* list element for locks */
-struct rcslock {
- char const * login;
- struct hshentry * delta;
- struct rcslock * nextlock;
-};
-
-/* list element for symbolic names */
-struct assoc {
- char const * symbol;
- char const * num;
- struct assoc * nextassoc;
-};
-
-
-#define mainArgs (argc,argv) int argc; char **argv;
-
-#if RCS_lint
-# define libId(name,rcsid)
-# define mainProg(name,cmd,rcsid) int name mainArgs
-#else
-# define libId(name,rcsid) char const name[] = rcsid;
-# define mainProg(n,c,i) char const Copyright[] = "Copyright 1982,1988,1989 Walter F. Tichy, Purdue CS\nCopyright 1990,1991,1992,1993,1994,1995 Paul Eggert", baseid[] = RCSBASE, cmdid[] = c; libId(n,i) int main P((int,char**)); int main mainArgs
-#endif
-
-/*
- * Markers for keyword expansion (used in co and ident)
- * Every byte must have class LETTER or Letter.
- */
-#define AUTHOR "Author"
-#define DATE "Date"
-#define HEADER "Header"
-#define IDH "Id"
-#define LOCKER "Locker"
-#define LOG "Log"
-#define NAME "Name"
-#define RCSFILE "RCSfile"
-#define REVISION "Revision"
-#define SOURCE "Source"
-#define STATE "State"
-#define CVSHEADER "CVSHeader"
-#define keylength 9 /* max length of any of the above keywords */
-
-enum markers { Nomatch, Author, Date, Header, Id,
- Locker, Log, Name, RCSfile, Revision, Source, State, CVSHeader,
- LocalId };
- /* This must be in the same order as rcskeys.c's Keyword[] array. */
-
-#define DELNUMFORM "\n\n%s\n%s\n"
-/* used by putdtext and scanlogtext */
-
-#define EMPTYLOG "*** empty log message ***" /* used by ci and rlog */
-
-/* main program */
-extern char const cmdid[];
-void exiterr P((void)) exiting;
-
-/* merge */
-int merge P((int,char const*,char const*const[3],char const*const[3]));
-
-/* rcsedit */
-#define ciklogsize 23 /* sizeof("checked in with -k by ") */
-extern FILE *fcopy;
-extern char const *resultname;
-extern char const ciklog[ciklogsize];
-extern int locker_expansion;
-RILE *rcswriteopen P((struct buf*,struct stat*,int));
-char const *makedirtemp P((int));
-char const *getcaller P((void));
-int addlock P((struct hshentry*,int));
-int addsymbol P((char const*,char const*,int));
-int checkaccesslist P((void));
-int chnamemod P((FILE**,char const*,char const*,int,mode_t,time_t));
-int donerewrite P((int,time_t));
-int dorewrite P((int,int));
-int expandline P((RILE*,FILE*,struct hshentry const*,int,FILE*,int));
-int findlock P((int,struct hshentry**));
-int setmtime P((char const*,time_t));
-void ORCSclose P((void));
-void ORCSerror P((void));
-void copystring P((void));
-void dirtempunlink P((void));
-void enterstring P((void));
-void finishedit P((struct hshentry const*,FILE*,int));
-void keepdirtemp P((char const*));
-void openfcopy P((FILE*));
-void snapshotedit P((FILE*));
-void xpandstring P((struct hshentry const*));
-#if has_NFS || bad_unlink
- int un_link P((char const*));
-#else
-# define un_link(s) unlink(s)
-#endif
-#if large_memory
- void edit_string P((void));
-# define editstring(delta) edit_string()
-#else
- void editstring P((struct hshentry const*));
-#endif
-
-/* rcsfcmp */
-int rcsfcmp P((RILE*,struct stat const*,char const*,struct hshentry const*));
-
-/* rcsfnms */
-#define bufautobegin(b) clear_buf(b)
-#define clear_buf(b) (VOID ((b)->string = 0, (b)->size = 0))
-extern FILE *workstdout;
-extern char *workname;
-extern char const *RCSname;
-extern char const *suffixes;
-extern int fdlock;
-extern struct stat RCSstat;
-RILE *rcsreadopen P((struct buf*,struct stat*,int));
-char *bufenlarge P((struct buf*,char const**));
-char const *basefilename P((char const*));
-char const *getfullRCSname P((void));
-char const *getfullCVSname P((void));
-char const *maketemp P((int));
-char const *rcssuffix P((char const*));
-int pairnames P((int,char**,RILE*(*)P((struct buf*,struct stat*,int)),int,int));
-struct cbuf bufremember P((struct buf*,size_t));
-void bufalloc P((struct buf*,size_t));
-void bufautoend P((struct buf*));
-void bufrealloc P((struct buf*,size_t));
-void bufscat P((struct buf*,char const*));
-void bufscpy P((struct buf*,char const*));
-void tempunlink P((void));
-
-/* rcsgen */
-extern int interactiveflag;
-extern struct buf curlogbuf;
-char const *buildrevision P((struct hshentries const*,struct hshentry*,FILE*,int));
-int getcstdin P((void));
-int putdtext P((struct hshentry const*,char const*,FILE*,int));
-int ttystdin P((void));
-int yesorno P((int,char const*,...)) printf_string(2,3);
-struct cbuf cleanlogmsg P((char*,size_t));
-struct cbuf getsstdin P((char const*,char const*,char const*,struct buf*));
-void putdesc P((int,char*));
-void putdftext P((struct hshentry const*,RILE*,FILE*,int));
-
-/* rcskeep */
-extern int prevkeys;
-extern struct buf prevauthor, prevdate, prevname, prevrev, prevstate;
-int getoldkeys P((RILE*));
-
-/* rcskeys */
-extern char const *Keyword[];
-extern enum markers LocalIdMode;
-enum markers trymatch P((char const*));
-void setRCSLocalId(char const *);
-void setIncExc(char const *);
-
-/* rcslex */
-extern FILE *foutptr;
-extern FILE *frewrite;
-extern RILE *finptr;
-extern char const *NextString;
-extern enum tokens nexttok;
-extern int hshenter;
-extern int nerror;
-extern int nextc;
-extern int quietflag;
-extern long rcsline;
-char const *getid P((void));
-void efaterror P((char const*)) exiting;
-void enfaterror P((int,char const*)) exiting;
-void fatcleanup P((int)) exiting;
-void faterror P((char const*,...)) printf_string_exiting(1,2);
-void fatserror P((char const*,...)) printf_string_exiting(1,2);
-void rcsfaterror P((char const*,...)) printf_string_exiting(1,2);
-void Ieof P((void)) exiting;
-void Ierror P((void)) exiting;
-void Oerror P((void)) exiting;
-char *checkid P((char*,int));
-char *checksym P((char*,int));
-int eoflex P((void));
-int getkeyopt P((char const*));
-int getlex P((enum tokens));
-struct cbuf getphrases P((char const*));
-struct cbuf savestring P((struct buf*));
-struct hshentry *getnum P((void));
-void Ifclose P((RILE*));
-void Izclose P((RILE**));
-void Lexinit P((void));
-void Ofclose P((FILE*));
-void Orewind P((FILE*));
-void Ozclose P((FILE**));
-void aflush P((FILE*));
-void afputc P((int,FILE*));
-void aprintf P((FILE*,char const*,...)) printf_string(2,3);
-void aputs P((char const*,FILE*));
-void checksid P((char*));
-void checkssym P((char*));
-void diagnose P((char const*,...)) printf_string(1,2);
-void eerror P((char const*));
-void eflush P((void));
-void enerror P((int,char const*));
-void error P((char const*,...)) printf_string(1,2);
-void fvfprintf P((FILE*,char const*,va_list));
-void getkey P((char const*));
-void getkeystring P((char const*));
-void nextlex P((void));
-void oflush P((void));
-void printstring P((void));
-void readstring P((void));
-void redefined P((int));
-void rcserror P((char const*,...)) printf_string(1,2);
-void rcswarn P((char const*,...)) printf_string(1,2);
-void testIerror P((FILE*));
-void testOerror P((FILE*));
-void warn P((char const*,...)) printf_string(1,2);
-void warnignore P((void));
-void workerror P((char const*,...)) printf_string(1,2);
-void workwarn P((char const*,...)) printf_string(1,2);
-#if has_madvise && has_mmap && large_memory
- void advise_access P((RILE*,int));
-# define if_advise_access(p,f,advice) if (p) advise_access(f,advice)
-#else
-# define advise_access(f,advice)
-# define if_advise_access(p,f,advice)
-#endif
-#if large_memory && maps_memory
- RILE *I_open P((char const*,struct stat*));
-# define Iopen(f,m,s) I_open(f,s)
-#else
- RILE *Iopen P((char const*,char const*,struct stat*));
-#endif
-#if !large_memory
- void testIeof P((FILE*));
- void Irewind P((RILE*));
-#endif
-
-/* rcsmap */
-extern enum tokens const ctab[];
-
-/* rcsrev */
-char *partialno P((struct buf*,char const*,int));
-char const *namedrev P((char const*,struct hshentry*));
-char const *tiprev P((void));
-int cmpdate P((char const*,char const*));
-int cmpnum P((char const*,char const*));
-int cmpnumfld P((char const*,char const*,int));
-int compartial P((char const*,char const*,int));
-int expandsym P((char const*,struct buf*));
-int fexpandsym P((char const*,struct buf*,RILE*));
-struct hshentry *genrevs P((char const*,char const*,char const*,char const*,struct hshentries**));
-int countnumflds P((char const*));
-void getbranchno P((char const*,struct buf*));
-
-/* rcssyn */
-/* These expand modes must agree with Expand_names[] in rcssyn.c. */
-#define KEYVAL_EXPAND 0 /* -kkv `$Keyword: value $' */
-#define KEYVALLOCK_EXPAND 1 /* -kkvl `$Keyword: value locker $' */
-#define KEY_EXPAND 2 /* -kk `$Keyword$' */
-#define VAL_EXPAND 3 /* -kv `value' */
-#define OLD_EXPAND 4 /* -ko use old string, omitting expansion */
-#define BINARY_EXPAND 5 /* -kb like -ko, but use binary mode I/O */
-#define MIN_UNEXPAND OLD_EXPAND /* min value for no logical expansion */
-#define MIN_UNCHANGED_EXPAND (OPEN_O_BINARY ? BINARY_EXPAND : OLD_EXPAND)
- /* min value guaranteed to yield an identical file */
-struct diffcmd {
- long
- line1, /* number of first line */
- nlines, /* number of lines affected */
- adprev, /* previous 'a' line1+1 or 'd' line1 */
- dafter; /* sum of previous 'd' line1 and previous 'd' nlines */
-};
-extern char const * Dbranch;
-extern struct access * AccessList;
-extern struct assoc * Symbols;
-extern struct cbuf Comment;
-extern struct cbuf Ignored;
-extern struct rcslock *Locks;
-extern struct hshentry * Head;
-extern int Expand;
-extern int StrictLocks;
-extern int TotalDeltas;
-extern char const *const expand_names[];
-extern char const
- Kaccess[], Kauthor[], Kbranch[], Kcomment[],
- Kdate[], Kdesc[], Kexpand[], Khead[], Klocks[], Klog[],
- Knext[], Kstate[], Kstrict[], Ksymbols[], Ktext[];
-void unexpected_EOF P((void)) exiting;
-int getdiffcmd P((RILE*,int,FILE*,struct diffcmd*));
-int str2expmode P((char const*));
-void getadmin P((void));
-void getdesc P((int));
-void gettree P((void));
-void ignorephrases P((char const*));
-void initdiffcmd P((struct diffcmd*));
-void putadmin P((void));
-void putstring P((FILE*,int,struct cbuf,int));
-void puttree P((struct hshentry const*,FILE*));
-
-/* rcstime */
-#define zonelenmax 9 /* maxiumum length of time zone string, e.g. "+12:34:56" */
-char const *date2str P((char const[datesize],char[datesize + zonelenmax]));
-time_t date2time P((char const[datesize]));
-void str2date P((char const*,char[datesize]));
-void time2date P((time_t,char[datesize]));
-void zone_set P((char const*));
-
-/* rcsutil */
-extern int RCSversion;
-FILE *fopenSafer P((char const*,char const*));
-char *cgetenv P((char const*));
-char *fstr_save P((char const*));
-char *str_save P((char const*));
-char const *getusername P((int));
-int fdSafer P((int));
-int getRCSINIT P((int,char**,char***));
-int run P((int,char const*,...));
-int runv P((int,char const*,char const**));
-malloc_type fremember P((malloc_type));
-malloc_type ftestalloc P((size_t));
-malloc_type testalloc P((size_t));
-malloc_type testrealloc P((malloc_type,size_t));
-#define ftalloc(T) ftnalloc(T,1)
-#define talloc(T) tnalloc(T,1)
-#if RCS_lint
- extern malloc_type lintalloc;
-# define ftnalloc(T,n) (lintalloc = ftestalloc(sizeof(T)*(n)), (T*)0)
-# define tnalloc(T,n) (lintalloc = testalloc(sizeof(T)*(n)), (T*)0)
-# define trealloc(T,p,n) (lintalloc = testrealloc((malloc_type)0, sizeof(T)*(n)), p)
-# define tfree(p)
-#else
-# define ftnalloc(T,n) ((T*) ftestalloc(sizeof(T)*(n)))
-# define tnalloc(T,n) ((T*) testalloc(sizeof(T)*(n)))
-# define trealloc(T,p,n) ((T*) testrealloc((malloc_type)(p), sizeof(T)*(n)))
-# define tfree(p) free((malloc_type)(p))
-#endif
-time_t now P((void));
-void awrite P((char const*,size_t,FILE*));
-void fastcopy P((RILE*,FILE*));
-void ffree P((void));
-void ffree1 P((char const*));
-void setRCSversion P((char const*));
-#if has_signal
- void catchints P((void));
- void ignoreints P((void));
- void restoreints P((void));
-#else
-# define catchints()
-# define ignoreints()
-# define restoreints()
-#endif
-#if has_mmap && large_memory
-# if has_NFS && mmap_signal
- void catchmmapints P((void));
- void readAccessFilenameBuffer P((char const*,unsigned char const*));
-# else
-# define catchmmapints()
-# endif
-#endif
-#if has_getuid
- uid_t ruid P((void));
-# define myself(u) ((u) == ruid())
-#else
-# define myself(u) true
-#endif
-#if has_setuid
- uid_t euid P((void));
- void nosetid P((void));
- void seteid P((void));
- void setrid P((void));
-#else
-# define nosetid()
-# define seteid()
-# define setrid()
-#endif
-
-/* version */
-extern char const RCS_version_string[];
diff --git a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsedit.c b/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsedit.c
deleted file mode 100644
index dc9dd30..0000000
--- a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsedit.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,1958 +0,0 @@
-/* RCS stream editor */
-
-/******************************************************************************
- * edits the input file according to a
- * script from stdin, generated by diff -n
- * performs keyword expansion
- ******************************************************************************
- */
-
-/* Copyright 1982, 1988, 1989 Walter Tichy
- Copyright 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995 Paul Eggert
- Distributed under license by the Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-
-This file is part of RCS.
-
-RCS is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
-it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
-any later version.
-
-RCS is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
-GNU General Public License for more details.
-
-You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-along with RCS; see the file COPYING.
-If not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
-59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
-
-Report problems and direct all questions to:
-
- rcs-bugs@cs.purdue.edu
-
-*/
-
-/*
- * Revision 5.19 1995/06/16 06:19:24 eggert
- * Update FSF address.
- *
- * Revision 5.18 1995/06/01 16:23:43 eggert
- * (dirtpname): No longer external.
- * (do_link): Simplify logic.
- * (finisheditline, finishedit): Replace Iseek/Itell with what they stand for.
- * (fopen_update_truncate): Replace `#if' with `if'.
- * (keyreplace, makedirtemp): dirlen(x) -> basefilename(x)-x.
- *
- * (edit_string): Fix bug: if !large_memory, a bogus trailing `@' was output
- * at the end of incomplete lines.
- *
- * (keyreplace): Do not assume that seeking backwards
- * at the start of a file will fail; on some systems it succeeds.
- * Convert C- and Pascal-style comment starts to ` *' in comment leader.
- *
- * (rcswriteopen): Use fdSafer to get safer file descriptor.
- * Open RCS file with FOPEN_RB.
- *
- * (chnamemod): Work around bad_NFS_rename bug; don't ignore un_link result.
- * Fall back on chmod if fchmod fails, since it might be ENOSYS.
- *
- * (aflush): Move to rcslex.c.
- *
- * Revision 5.17 1994/03/20 04:52:58 eggert
- * Normally calculate the $Log prefix from context, not from RCS file.
- * Move setmtime here from rcsutil.c. Add ORCSerror. Remove lint.
- *
- * Revision 5.16 1993/11/03 17:42:27 eggert
- * Add -z. Add Name keyword. If bad_unlink, ignore errno when unlink fails.
- * Escape white space, $, and \ in keyword string file names.
- * Don't output 2 spaces between date and time after Log.
- *
- * Revision 5.15 1992/07/28 16:12:44 eggert
- * Some hosts have readlink but not ELOOP. Avoid `unsigned'.
- * Preserve dates more systematically. Statement macro names now end in _.
- *
- * Revision 5.14 1992/02/17 23:02:24 eggert
- * Add -T support.
- *
- * Revision 5.13 1992/01/24 18:44:19 eggert
- * Add support for bad_chmod_close, bad_creat0.
- *
- * Revision 5.12 1992/01/06 02:42:34 eggert
- * Add setmode parameter to chnamemod. addsymbol now reports changes.
- * while (E) ; -> while (E) continue;
- *
- * Revision 5.11 1991/11/03 01:11:44 eggert
- * Move the warning about link breaking to where they're actually being broken.
- *
- * Revision 5.10 1991/10/07 17:32:46 eggert
- * Support piece tables even if !has_mmap. Fix rare NFS bugs.
- *
- * Revision 5.9 1991/09/17 19:07:40 eggert
- * SGI readlink() yields ENXIO, not EINVAL, for nonlinks.
- *
- * Revision 5.8 1991/08/19 03:13:55 eggert
- * Add piece tables, NFS bug workarounds. Catch odd filenames. Tune.
- *
- * Revision 5.7 1991/04/21 11:58:21 eggert
- * Fix errno bugs. Add -x, RCSINIT, MS-DOS support.
- *
- * Revision 5.6 1991/02/25 07:12:40 eggert
- * Fix setuid bug. Support new link behavior. Work around broken "w+" fopen.
- *
- * Revision 5.5 1990/12/30 05:07:35 eggert
- * Fix report of busy RCS files when !defined(O_CREAT) | !defined(O_EXCL).
- *
- * Revision 5.4 1990/11/01 05:03:40 eggert
- * Permit arbitrary data in comment leaders.
- *
- * Revision 5.3 1990/09/11 02:41:13 eggert
- * Tune expandline().
- *
- * Revision 5.2 1990/09/04 08:02:21 eggert
- * Count RCS lines better. Improve incomplete line handling.
- *
- * Revision 5.1 1990/08/29 07:13:56 eggert
- * Add -kkvl.
- * Fix bug when getting revisions to files ending in incomplete lines.
- * Fix bug in comment leader expansion.
- *
- * Revision 5.0 1990/08/22 08:12:47 eggert
- * Don't require final newline.
- * Don't append "checked in with -k by " to logs,
- * so that checking in a program with -k doesn't change it.
- * Don't generate trailing white space for empty comment leader.
- * Remove compile-time limits; use malloc instead. Add -k, -V.
- * Permit dates past 1999/12/31. Make lock and temp files faster and safer.
- * Ansify and Posixate. Check diff's output.
- *
- * Revision 4.8 89/05/01 15:12:35 narten
- * changed copyright header to reflect current distribution rules
- *
- * Revision 4.7 88/11/08 13:54:14 narten
- * misplaced semicolon caused infinite loop
- *
- * Revision 4.6 88/08/09 19:12:45 eggert
- * Shrink stdio code size; allow cc -R.
- *
- * Revision 4.5 87/12/18 11:38:46 narten
- * Changes from the 43. version. Don't know the significance of the
- * first change involving "rewind". Also, additional "lint" cleanup.
- * (Guy Harris)
- *
- * Revision 4.4 87/10/18 10:32:21 narten
- * Updating version numbers. Changes relative to version 1.1 actually
- * relative to 4.1
- *
- * Revision 1.4 87/09/24 13:59:29 narten
- * Sources now pass through lint (if you ignore printf/sprintf/fprintf
- * warnings)
- *
- * Revision 1.3 87/09/15 16:39:39 shepler
- * added an initializatin of the variables editline and linecorr
- * this will be done each time a file is processed.
- * (there was an obscure bug where if co was used to retrieve multiple files
- * it would dump)
- * fix attributed to Roy Morris @FileNet Corp ...!felix!roy
- *
- * Revision 1.2 87/03/27 14:22:17 jenkins
- * Port to suns
- *
- * Revision 4.1 83/05/12 13:10:30 wft
- * Added new markers Id and RCSfile; added locker to Header and Id.
- * Overhauled expandline completely() (problem with $01234567890123456789@).
- * Moved trymatch() and marker table to rcskeys.c.
- *
- * Revision 3.7 83/05/12 13:04:39 wft
- * Added retry to expandline to resume after failed match which ended in $.
- * Fixed truncation problem for $19chars followed by@@.
- * Log no longer expands full path of RCS file.
- *
- * Revision 3.6 83/05/11 16:06:30 wft
- * added retry to expandline to resume after failed match which ended in $.
- * Fixed truncation problem for $19chars followed by@@.
- *
- * Revision 3.5 82/12/04 13:20:56 wft
- * Added expansion of keyword Locker.
- *
- * Revision 3.4 82/12/03 12:26:54 wft
- * Added line number correction in case editing does not start at the
- * beginning of the file.
- * Changed keyword expansion to always print a space before closing KDELIM;
- * Expansion for Header shortened.
- *
- * Revision 3.3 82/11/14 14:49:30 wft
- * removed Suffix from keyword expansion. Replaced fclose with ffclose.
- * keyreplace() gets log message from delta, not from curlogmsg.
- * fixed expression overflow in while(c=putc(GETC....
- * checked nil printing.
- *
- * Revision 3.2 82/10/18 21:13:39 wft
- * I added checks for write errors during the co process, and renamed
- * expandstring() to xpandstring().
- *
- * Revision 3.1 82/10/13 15:52:55 wft
- * changed type of result of getc() from char to int.
- * made keyword expansion loop in expandline() portable to machines
- * without sign-extension.
- */
-
-
-#include "rcsbase.h"
-
-libId(editId, "$FreeBSD$")
-
-static void editEndsPrematurely P((void)) exiting;
-static void editLineNumberOverflow P((void)) exiting;
-static void escape_string P((FILE*,char const*));
-static void keyreplace P((enum markers,struct hshentry const*,int,RILE*,FILE*,int));
-
-FILE *fcopy; /* result file descriptor */
-char const *resultname; /* result pathname */
-int locker_expansion; /* should the locker name be appended to Id val? */
-#if !large_memory
- static RILE *fedit; /* edit file descriptor */
- static char const *editname; /* edit pathname */
-#endif
-static long editline; /* edit line counter; #lines before cursor */
-static long linecorr; /* #adds - #deletes in each edit run. */
- /*used to correct editline in case file is not rewound after */
- /* applying one delta */
-
-/* indexes into dirtpname */
-#define lockdirtp_index 0
-#define newRCSdirtp_index bad_creat0
-#define newworkdirtp_index (newRCSdirtp_index+1)
-#define DIRTEMPNAMES (newworkdirtp_index + 1)
-
-enum maker {notmade, real, effective};
-static struct buf dirtpname[DIRTEMPNAMES]; /* unlink these when done */
-static enum maker volatile dirtpmaker[DIRTEMPNAMES]; /* if these are set */
-#define lockname (dirtpname[lockdirtp_index].string)
-#define newRCSname (dirtpname[newRCSdirtp_index].string)
-
-
-#if has_NFS || bad_unlink
- int
-un_link(s)
- char const *s;
-/*
- * Remove S, even if it is unwritable.
- * Ignore unlink() ENOENT failures; NFS generates bogus ones.
- */
-{
-# if bad_unlink
- if (unlink(s) == 0)
- return 0;
- else {
- int e = errno;
- /*
- * Forge ahead even if errno == ENOENT; some completely
- * brain-damaged hosts (e.g. PCTCP 2.2) yield ENOENT
- * even for existing unwritable files.
- */
- if (chmod(s, S_IWUSR) != 0) {
- errno = e;
- return -1;
- }
- }
-# endif
-# if has_NFS
- return unlink(s)==0 || errno==ENOENT ? 0 : -1;
-# else
- return unlink(s);
-# endif
-}
-#endif
-
-#if !has_rename
-# if !has_NFS
-# define do_link(s,t) link(s,t)
-# else
- static int do_link P((char const*,char const*));
- static int
-do_link(s, t)
- char const *s, *t;
-/* Link S to T, ignoring bogus EEXIST problems due to NFS failures. */
-{
- int r = link(s, t);
-
- if (r != 0 && errno == EEXIST) {
- struct stat sb, tb;
- if (
- stat(s, &sb) == 0 &&
- stat(t, &tb) == 0 &&
- same_file(sb, tb, 0)
- )
- r = 0;
- errno = EEXIST;
- }
- return r;
-}
-# endif
-#endif
-
-
- static void
-editEndsPrematurely()
-{
- fatserror("edit script ends prematurely");
-}
-
- static void
-editLineNumberOverflow()
-{
- fatserror("edit script refers to line past end of file");
-}
-
-
-#if large_memory
-
-#if has_memmove
-# define movelines(s1, s2, n) VOID memmove(s1, s2, (n)*sizeof(Iptr_type))
-#else
- static void movelines P((Iptr_type*,Iptr_type const*,long));
- static void
-movelines(s1, s2, n)
- register Iptr_type *s1;
- register Iptr_type const *s2;
- register long n;
-{
- if (s1 < s2)
- do {
- *s1++ = *s2++;
- } while (--n);
- else {
- s1 += n;
- s2 += n;
- do {
- *--s1 = *--s2;
- } while (--n);
- }
-}
-#endif
-
-static void deletelines P((long,long));
-static void finisheditline P((RILE*,FILE*,Iptr_type,struct hshentry const*));
-static void insertline P((long,Iptr_type));
-static void snapshotline P((FILE*,Iptr_type));
-
-/*
- * `line' contains pointers to the lines in the currently `edited' file.
- * It is a 0-origin array that represents linelim-gapsize lines.
- * line[0 .. gap-1] and line[gap+gapsize .. linelim-1] hold pointers to lines.
- * line[gap .. gap+gapsize-1] contains garbage.
- *
- * Any @s in lines are duplicated.
- * Lines are terminated by \n, or (for a last partial line only) by single @.
- */
-static Iptr_type *line;
-static size_t gap, gapsize, linelim;
-
- static void
-insertline(n, l)
- long n;
- Iptr_type l;
-/* Before line N, insert line L. N is 0-origin. */
-{
- if (linelim-gapsize < n)
- editLineNumberOverflow();
- if (!gapsize)
- line =
- !linelim ?
- tnalloc(Iptr_type, linelim = gapsize = 1024)
- : (
- gap = gapsize = linelim,
- trealloc(Iptr_type, line, linelim <<= 1)
- );
- if (n < gap)
- movelines(line+n+gapsize, line+n, gap-n);
- else if (gap < n)
- movelines(line+gap, line+gap+gapsize, n-gap);
-
- line[n] = l;
- gap = n + 1;
- gapsize--;
-}
-
- static void
-deletelines(n, nlines)
- long n, nlines;
-/* Delete lines N through N+NLINES-1. N is 0-origin. */
-{
- long l = n + nlines;
- if (linelim-gapsize < l || l < n)
- editLineNumberOverflow();
- if (l < gap)
- movelines(line+l+gapsize, line+l, gap-l);
- else if (gap < n)
- movelines(line+gap, line+gap+gapsize, n-gap);
-
- gap = n;
- gapsize += nlines;
-}
-
- static void
-snapshotline(f, l)
- register FILE *f;
- register Iptr_type l;
-{
- register int c;
- do {
- if ((c = *l++) == SDELIM && *l++ != SDELIM)
- return;
- aputc_(c, f)
- } while (c != '\n');
-}
-
- void
-snapshotedit(f)
- FILE *f;
-/* Copy the current state of the edits to F. */
-{
- register Iptr_type *p, *lim, *l=line;
- for (p=l, lim=l+gap; p<lim; )
- snapshotline(f, *p++);
- for (p+=gapsize, lim=l+linelim; p<lim; )
- snapshotline(f, *p++);
-}
-
- static void
-finisheditline(fin, fout, l, delta)
- RILE *fin;
- FILE *fout;
- Iptr_type l;
- struct hshentry const *delta;
-{
- fin->ptr = l;
- if (expandline(fin, fout, delta, true, (FILE*)0, true) < 0)
- faterror("finisheditline internal error");
-}
-
- void
-finishedit(delta, outfile, done)
- struct hshentry const *delta;
- FILE *outfile;
- int done;
-/*
- * Doing expansion if DELTA is set, output the state of the edits to OUTFILE.
- * But do nothing unless DONE is set (which means we are on the last pass).
- */
-{
- if (done) {
- openfcopy(outfile);
- outfile = fcopy;
- if (!delta)
- snapshotedit(outfile);
- else {
- register Iptr_type *p, *lim, *l = line;
- register RILE *fin = finptr;
- Iptr_type here = fin->ptr;
- for (p=l, lim=l+gap; p<lim; )
- finisheditline(fin, outfile, *p++, delta);
- for (p+=gapsize, lim=l+linelim; p<lim; )
- finisheditline(fin, outfile, *p++, delta);
- fin->ptr = here;
- }
- }
-}
-
-/* Open a temporary NAME for output, truncating any previous contents. */
-# define fopen_update_truncate(name) fopenSafer(name, FOPEN_W_WORK)
-#else /* !large_memory */
- static FILE * fopen_update_truncate P((char const*));
- static FILE *
-fopen_update_truncate(name)
- char const *name;
-{
- if (bad_fopen_wplus && un_link(name) != 0)
- efaterror(name);
- return fopenSafer(name, FOPEN_WPLUS_WORK);
-}
-#endif
-
-
- void
-openfcopy(f)
- FILE *f;
-{
- if (!(fcopy = f)) {
- if (!resultname)
- resultname = maketemp(2);
- if (!(fcopy = fopen_update_truncate(resultname)))
- efaterror(resultname);
- }
-}
-
-
-#if !large_memory
-
- static void swapeditfiles P((FILE*));
- static void
-swapeditfiles(outfile)
- FILE *outfile;
-/* Function: swaps resultname and editname, assigns fedit=fcopy,
- * and rewinds fedit for reading. Set fcopy to outfile if nonnull;
- * otherwise, set fcopy to be resultname opened for reading and writing.
- */
-{
- char const *tmpptr;
-
- editline = 0; linecorr = 0;
- Orewind(fcopy);
- fedit = fcopy;
- tmpptr=editname; editname=resultname; resultname=tmpptr;
- openfcopy(outfile);
-}
-
- void
-snapshotedit(f)
- FILE *f;
-/* Copy the current state of the edits to F. */
-{
- finishedit((struct hshentry *)0, (FILE*)0, false);
- fastcopy(fedit, f);
- Irewind(fedit);
-}
-
- void
-finishedit(delta, outfile, done)
- struct hshentry const *delta;
- FILE *outfile;
- int done;
-/* copy the rest of the edit file and close it (if it exists).
- * if delta, perform keyword substitution at the same time.
- * If DONE is set, we are finishing the last pass.
- */
-{
- register RILE *fe;
- register FILE *fc;
-
- fe = fedit;
- if (fe) {
- fc = fcopy;
- if (delta) {
- while (1 < expandline(fe,fc,delta,false,(FILE*)0,true))
- ;
- } else {
- fastcopy(fe,fc);
- }
- Ifclose(fe);
- }
- if (!done)
- swapeditfiles(outfile);
-}
-#endif
-
-
-
-#if large_memory
-# define copylines(upto,delta) (editline = (upto))
-#else
- static void copylines P((long,struct hshentry const*));
- static void
-copylines(upto, delta)
- register long upto;
- struct hshentry const *delta;
-/*
- * Copy input lines editline+1..upto from fedit to fcopy.
- * If delta, keyword expansion is done simultaneously.
- * editline is updated. Rewinds a file only if necessary.
- */
-{
- register int c;
- declarecache;
- register FILE *fc;
- register RILE *fe;
-
- if (upto < editline) {
- /* swap files */
- finishedit((struct hshentry *)0, (FILE*)0, false);
- /* assumes edit only during last pass, from the beginning*/
- }
- fe = fedit;
- fc = fcopy;
- if (editline < upto)
- if (delta)
- do {
- if (expandline(fe,fc,delta,false,(FILE*)0,true) <= 1)
- editLineNumberOverflow();
- } while (++editline < upto);
- else {
- setupcache(fe); cache(fe);
- do {
- do {
- cachegeteof_(c, editLineNumberOverflow();)
- aputc_(c, fc)
- } while (c != '\n');
- } while (++editline < upto);
- uncache(fe);
- }
-}
-#endif
-
-
-
- void
-xpandstring(delta)
- struct hshentry const *delta;
-/* Function: Reads a string terminated by SDELIM from finptr and writes it
- * to fcopy. Double SDELIM is replaced with single SDELIM.
- * Keyword expansion is performed with data from delta.
- * If foutptr is nonnull, the string is also copied unchanged to foutptr.
- */
-{
- while (1 < expandline(finptr,fcopy,delta,true,foutptr,true))
- continue;
-}
-
-
- void
-copystring()
-/* Function: copies a string terminated with a single SDELIM from finptr to
- * fcopy, replacing all double SDELIM with a single SDELIM.
- * If foutptr is nonnull, the string also copied unchanged to foutptr.
- * editline is incremented by the number of lines copied.
- * Assumption: next character read is first string character.
- */
-{ register c;
- declarecache;
- register FILE *frew, *fcop;
- register int amidline;
- register RILE *fin;
-
- fin = finptr;
- setupcache(fin); cache(fin);
- frew = foutptr;
- fcop = fcopy;
- amidline = false;
- for (;;) {
- GETC_(frew,c)
- switch (c) {
- case '\n':
- ++editline;
- ++rcsline;
- amidline = false;
- break;
- case SDELIM:
- GETC_(frew,c)
- if (c != SDELIM) {
- /* end of string */
- nextc = c;
- editline += amidline;
- uncache(fin);
- return;
- }
- /* fall into */
- default:
- amidline = true;
- break;
- }
- aputc_(c,fcop)
- }
-}
-
-
- void
-enterstring()
-/* Like copystring, except the string is put into the edit data structure. */
-{
-#if !large_memory
- editname = 0;
- fedit = 0;
- editline = linecorr = 0;
- resultname = maketemp(1);
- if (!(fcopy = fopen_update_truncate(resultname)))
- efaterror(resultname);
- copystring();
-#else
- register int c;
- declarecache;
- register FILE *frew;
- register long e, oe;
- register int amidline, oamidline;
- register Iptr_type optr;
- register RILE *fin;
-
- e = 0;
- gap = 0;
- gapsize = linelim;
- fin = finptr;
- setupcache(fin); cache(fin);
- advise_access(fin, MADV_NORMAL);
- frew = foutptr;
- amidline = false;
- for (;;) {
- optr = cacheptr();
- GETC_(frew,c)
- oamidline = amidline;
- oe = e;
- switch (c) {
- case '\n':
- ++e;
- ++rcsline;
- amidline = false;
- break;
- case SDELIM:
- GETC_(frew,c)
- if (c != SDELIM) {
- /* end of string */
- nextc = c;
- editline = e + amidline;
- linecorr = 0;
- uncache(fin);
- return;
- }
- /* fall into */
- default:
- amidline = true;
- break;
- }
- if (!oamidline)
- insertline(oe, optr);
- }
-#endif
-}
-
-
-
-
- void
-#if large_memory
-edit_string()
-#else
- editstring(delta)
- struct hshentry const *delta;
-#endif
-/*
- * Read an edit script from finptr and applies it to the edit file.
-#if !large_memory
- * The result is written to fcopy.
- * If delta, keyword expansion is performed simultaneously.
- * If running out of lines in fedit, fedit and fcopy are swapped.
- * editname is the name of the file that goes with fedit.
-#endif
- * If foutptr is set, the edit script is also copied verbatim to foutptr.
- * Assumes that all these files are open.
- * resultname is the name of the file that goes with fcopy.
- * Assumes the next input character from finptr is the first character of
- * the edit script. Resets nextc on exit.
- */
-{
- int ed; /* editor command */
- register int c;
- declarecache;
- register FILE *frew;
-# if !large_memory
- register FILE *f;
- long line_lim = LONG_MAX;
- register RILE *fe;
-# endif
- register long i;
- register RILE *fin;
-# if large_memory
- register long j;
-# endif
- struct diffcmd dc;
-
- editline += linecorr; linecorr=0; /*correct line number*/
- frew = foutptr;
- fin = finptr;
- setupcache(fin);
- initdiffcmd(&dc);
- while (0 <= (ed = getdiffcmd(fin,true,frew,&dc)))
-#if !large_memory
- if (line_lim <= dc.line1)
- editLineNumberOverflow();
- else
-#endif
- if (!ed) {
- copylines(dc.line1-1, delta);
- /* skip over unwanted lines */
- i = dc.nlines;
- linecorr -= i;
- editline += i;
-# if large_memory
- deletelines(editline+linecorr, i);
-# else
- fe = fedit;
- do {
- /*skip next line*/
- do {
- Igeteof_(fe, c, { if (i!=1) editLineNumberOverflow(); line_lim = dc.dafter; break; } )
- } while (c != '\n');
- } while (--i);
-# endif
- } else {
- /* Copy lines without deleting any. */
- copylines(dc.line1, delta);
- i = dc.nlines;
-# if large_memory
- j = editline+linecorr;
-# endif
- linecorr += i;
-#if !large_memory
- f = fcopy;
- if (delta)
- do {
- switch (expandline(fin,f,delta,true,frew,true)){
- case 0: case 1:
- if (i==1)
- return;
- /* fall into */
- case -1:
- editEndsPrematurely();
- }
- } while (--i);
- else
-#endif
- {
- cache(fin);
- do {
-# if large_memory
- insertline(j++, cacheptr());
-# endif
- for (;;) {
- GETC_(frew, c)
- if (c==SDELIM) {
- GETC_(frew, c)
- if (c!=SDELIM) {
- if (--i)
- editEndsPrematurely();
- nextc = c;
- uncache(fin);
- return;
- }
- }
-# if !large_memory
- aputc_(c, f)
-# endif
- if (c == '\n')
- break;
- }
- ++rcsline;
- } while (--i);
- uncache(fin);
- }
- }
-}
-
-
-
-/* The rest is for keyword expansion */
-
-
-
- int
-expandline(infile, outfile, delta, delimstuffed, frewfile, dolog)
- RILE *infile;
- FILE *outfile, *frewfile;
- struct hshentry const *delta;
- int delimstuffed, dolog;
-/*
- * Read a line from INFILE and write it to OUTFILE.
- * Do keyword expansion with data from DELTA.
- * If DELIMSTUFFED is true, double SDELIM is replaced with single SDELIM.
- * If FREWFILE is set, copy the line unchanged to FREWFILE.
- * DELIMSTUFFED must be true if FREWFILE is set.
- * Append revision history to log only if DOLOG is set.
- * Yields -1 if no data is copied, 0 if an incomplete line is copied,
- * 2 if a complete line is copied; adds 1 to yield if expansion occurred.
- */
-{
- register c;
- declarecache;
- register FILE *out, *frew;
- register char * tp;
- register int e, ds, r;
- char const *tlim;
- static struct buf keyval;
- enum markers matchresult;
-
- setupcache(infile); cache(infile);
- out = outfile;
- frew = frewfile;
- ds = delimstuffed;
- bufalloc(&keyval, keylength+3);
- e = 0;
- r = -1;
-
- for (;;) {
- if (ds)
- GETC_(frew, c)
- else
- cachegeteof_(c, goto uncache_exit;)
- for (;;) {
- switch (c) {
- case SDELIM:
- if (ds) {
- GETC_(frew, c)
- if (c != SDELIM) {
- /* end of string */
- nextc=c;
- goto uncache_exit;
- }
- }
- /* fall into */
- default:
- aputc_(c,out)
- r = 0;
- break;
-
- case '\n':
- rcsline += ds;
- aputc_(c,out)
- r = 2;
- goto uncache_exit;
-
- case KDELIM:
- r = 0;
- /* check for keyword */
- /* first, copy a long enough string into keystring */
- tp = keyval.string;
- *tp++ = KDELIM;
- for (;;) {
- if (ds)
- GETC_(frew, c)
- else
- cachegeteof_(c, goto keystring_eof;)
- if (tp <= &keyval.string[keylength])
- switch (ctab[c]) {
- case LETTER: case Letter:
- *tp++ = c;
- continue;
- default:
- break;
- }
- break;
- }
- *tp++ = c; *tp = '\0';
- matchresult = trymatch(keyval.string+1);
- if (matchresult==Nomatch) {
- tp[-1] = 0;
- aputs(keyval.string, out);
- continue; /* last c handled properly */
- }
-
- /* Now we have a keyword terminated with a K/VDELIM */
- if (c==VDELIM) {
- /* try to find closing KDELIM, and replace value */
- tlim = keyval.string + keyval.size;
- for (;;) {
- if (ds)
- GETC_(frew, c)
- else
- cachegeteof_(c, goto keystring_eof;)
- if (c=='\n' || c==KDELIM)
- break;
- *tp++ =c;
- if (tlim <= tp)
- tp = bufenlarge(&keyval, &tlim);
- if (c==SDELIM && ds) { /*skip next SDELIM */
- GETC_(frew, c)
- if (c != SDELIM) {
- /* end of string before closing KDELIM or newline */
- nextc = c;
- goto keystring_eof;
- }
- }
- }
- if (c!=KDELIM) {
- /* couldn't find closing KDELIM -- give up */
- *tp = 0;
- aputs(keyval.string, out);
- continue; /* last c handled properly */
- }
- }
- /* now put out the new keyword value */
- uncache(infile);
- keyreplace(matchresult, delta, ds, infile, out, dolog);
- cache(infile);
- e = 1;
- break;
- }
- break;
- }
- }
-
- keystring_eof:
- *tp = 0;
- aputs(keyval.string, out);
- uncache_exit:
- uncache(infile);
- return r + e;
-}
-
-
- static void
-escape_string(out, s)
- register FILE *out;
- register char const *s;
-/* Output to OUT the string S, escaping chars that would break `ci -k'. */
-{
- register char c;
- for (;;)
- switch ((c = *s++)) {
- case 0: return;
- case '\t': aputs("\\t", out); break;
- case '\n': aputs("\\n", out); break;
- case ' ': aputs("\\040", out); break;
- case KDELIM: aputs("\\044", out); break;
- case '\\': if (VERSION(5)<=RCSversion) {aputs("\\\\", out); break;}
- /* fall into */
- default: aputc_(c, out) break;
- }
-}
-
-char const ciklog[ciklogsize] = "checked in with -k by ";
-
- static void
-keyreplace(marker, delta, delimstuffed, infile, out, dolog)
- enum markers marker;
- register struct hshentry const *delta;
- int delimstuffed;
- RILE *infile;
- register FILE *out;
- int dolog;
-/* function: outputs the keyword value(s) corresponding to marker.
- * Attributes are derived from delta.
- */
-{
- register char const *sp, *cp, *date;
- register int c;
- register size_t cs, cw, ls;
- char const *sp1;
- char datebuf[datesize + zonelenmax];
- int RCSv;
- int exp;
-
- sp = Keyword[(int)marker];
- exp = Expand;
- date = delta->date;
- RCSv = RCSversion;
-
- if (exp != VAL_EXPAND)
- aprintf(out, "%c%s", KDELIM, sp);
- if (exp != KEY_EXPAND) {
-
- if (exp != VAL_EXPAND)
- aprintf(out, "%c%c", VDELIM,
- marker==Log && RCSv<VERSION(5) ? '\t' : ' '
- );
-
- switch (marker) {
- case Author:
- aputs(delta->author, out);
- break;
- case Date:
- aputs(date2str(date,datebuf), out);
- break;
- case Id:
- case LocalId:
- case Header:
- case CVSHeader:
- if (marker == Id || RCSv < VERSION(4) ||
- (marker == LocalId && LocalIdMode == Id))
- escape_string(out, basefilename(RCSname));
- else if (marker == CVSHeader ||
- (marker == LocalId && LocalIdMode == CVSHeader))
- escape_string(out, getfullCVSname());
- else
- escape_string(out, getfullRCSname());
- aprintf(out, " %s %s %s %s",
- delta->num,
- date2str(date, datebuf),
- delta->author,
- RCSv==VERSION(3) && delta->lockedby ? "Locked"
- : delta->state
- );
- if (delta->lockedby)
- if (VERSION(5) <= RCSv) {
- if (locker_expansion || exp==KEYVALLOCK_EXPAND)
- aprintf(out, " %s", delta->lockedby);
- } else if (RCSv == VERSION(4))
- aprintf(out, " Locker: %s", delta->lockedby);
- break;
- case Locker:
- if (delta->lockedby)
- if (
- locker_expansion
- || exp == KEYVALLOCK_EXPAND
- || RCSv <= VERSION(4)
- )
- aputs(delta->lockedby, out);
- break;
- case Log:
- case RCSfile:
- escape_string(out, basefilename(RCSname));
- break;
- case Name:
- if (delta->name)
- aputs(delta->name, out);
- break;
- case Revision:
- aputs(delta->num, out);
- break;
- case Source:
- escape_string(out, getfullRCSname());
- break;
- case State:
- aputs(delta->state, out);
- break;
- default:
- break;
- }
- if (exp != VAL_EXPAND)
- afputc(' ', out);
- }
- if (exp != VAL_EXPAND)
- afputc(KDELIM, out);
-
- if (marker == Log && dolog) {
- struct buf leader;
-
- sp = delta->log.string;
- ls = delta->log.size;
- if (sizeof(ciklog)-1<=ls && !memcmp(sp,ciklog,sizeof(ciklog)-1))
- return;
- bufautobegin(&leader);
- if (RCSversion < VERSION(5)) {
- cp = Comment.string;
- cs = Comment.size;
- } else {
- int kdelim_found = 0;
- Ioffset_type chars_read = Itell(infile);
- declarecache;
- setupcache(infile); cache(infile);
-
- c = 0; /* Pacify `gcc -Wall'. */
-
- /*
- * Back up to the start of the current input line,
- * setting CS to the number of characters before `$Log'.
- */
- cs = 0;
- for (;;) {
- if (!--chars_read)
- goto done_backing_up;
- cacheunget_(infile, c)
- if (c == '\n')
- break;
- if (c == SDELIM && delimstuffed) {
- if (!--chars_read)
- break;
- cacheunget_(infile, c)
- if (c != SDELIM) {
- cacheget_(c)
- break;
- }
- }
- cs += kdelim_found;
- kdelim_found |= c==KDELIM;
- }
- cacheget_(c)
- done_backing_up:;
-
- /* Copy characters before `$Log' into LEADER. */
- bufalloc(&leader, cs);
- cp = leader.string;
- for (cw = 0; cw < cs; cw++) {
- leader.string[cw] = c;
- if (c == SDELIM && delimstuffed)
- cacheget_(c)
- cacheget_(c)
- }
-
- /* Convert traditional C or Pascal leader to ` *'. */
- for (cw = 0; cw < cs; cw++)
- if (ctab[(unsigned char) cp[cw]] != SPACE)
- break;
- if (
- cw+1 < cs
- && cp[cw+1] == '*'
- && (cp[cw] == '/' || cp[cw] == '(')
- ) {
- size_t i = cw+1;
- for (;;)
- if (++i == cs) {
- warn(
- "`%c* $Log' is obsolescent; use ` * $Log'.",
- cp[cw]
- );
- leader.string[cw] = ' ';
- break;
- } else if (ctab[(unsigned char) cp[i]] != SPACE)
- break;
- }
-
- /* Skip `$Log ... $' string. */
- do {
- cacheget_(c)
- } while (c != KDELIM);
- uncache(infile);
- }
- afputc('\n', out);
- awrite(cp, cs, out);
- sp1 = date2str(date, datebuf);
- if (VERSION(5) <= RCSv) {
- aprintf(out, "Revision %s %s %s",
- delta->num, sp1, delta->author
- );
- } else {
- /* oddity: 2 spaces between date and time, not 1 as usual */
- sp1 = strchr(sp1, ' ');
- aprintf(out, "Revision %s %.*s %s %s",
- delta->num, (int)(sp1-datebuf), datebuf, sp1,
- delta->author
- );
- }
- /* Do not include state: it may change and is not updated. */
- cw = cs;
- if (VERSION(5) <= RCSv)
- for (; cw && (cp[cw-1]==' ' || cp[cw-1]=='\t'); --cw)
- continue;
- for (;;) {
- afputc('\n', out);
- awrite(cp, cw, out);
- if (!ls)
- break;
- --ls;
- c = *sp++;
- if (c != '\n') {
- awrite(cp+cw, cs-cw, out);
- do {
- afputc(c,out);
- if (!ls)
- break;
- --ls;
- c = *sp++;
- } while (c != '\n');
- }
- }
- bufautoend(&leader);
- }
-}
-
-#if has_readlink
- static int resolve_symlink P((struct buf*));
- static int
-resolve_symlink(L)
- struct buf *L;
-/*
- * If L is a symbolic link, resolve it to the name that it points to.
- * If unsuccessful, set errno and yield -1.
- * If it points to an existing file, yield 1.
- * Otherwise, set errno=ENOENT and yield 0.
- */
-{
- char *b, a[SIZEABLE_PATH];
- int e;
- size_t s;
- ssize_t r;
- struct buf bigbuf;
- int linkcount = MAXSYMLINKS;
-
- b = a;
- s = sizeof(a);
- bufautobegin(&bigbuf);
- while ((r = readlink(L->string,b,s)) != -1)
- if (r == s) {
- bufalloc(&bigbuf, s<<1);
- b = bigbuf.string;
- s = bigbuf.size;
- } else if (!linkcount--) {
-# ifndef ELOOP
- /*
- * Some pedantic Posix 1003.1-1990 hosts have readlink
- * but not ELOOP. Approximate ELOOP with EMLINK.
- */
-# define ELOOP EMLINK
-# endif
- errno = ELOOP;
- return -1;
- } else {
- /* Splice symbolic link into L. */
- b[r] = '\0';
- L->string[
- ROOTPATH(b) ? 0 : basefilename(L->string) - L->string
- ] = '\0';
- bufscat(L, b);
- }
- e = errno;
- bufautoend(&bigbuf);
- errno = e;
- switch (e) {
- case readlink_isreg_errno: return 1;
- case ENOENT: return 0;
- default: return -1;
- }
-}
-#endif
-
- RILE *
-rcswriteopen(RCSbuf, status, mustread)
- struct buf *RCSbuf;
- struct stat *status;
- int mustread;
-/*
- * Create the lock file corresponding to RCSBUF.
- * Then try to open RCSBUF for reading and yield its RILE* descriptor.
- * Put its status into *STATUS too.
- * MUSTREAD is true if the file must already exist, too.
- * If all goes well, discard any previously acquired locks,
- * and set fdlock to the file descriptor of the RCS lockfile.
- */
-{
- register char *tp;
- register char const *sp, *RCSpath, *x;
- RILE *f;
- size_t l;
- int e, exists, fdesc, fdescSafer, r, waslocked;
- struct buf *dirt;
- struct stat statbuf;
-
- waslocked = 0 <= fdlock;
- exists =
-# if has_readlink
- resolve_symlink(RCSbuf);
-# else
- stat(RCSbuf->string, &statbuf) == 0 ? 1
- : errno==ENOENT ? 0 : -1;
-# endif
- if (exists < (mustread|waslocked))
- /*
- * There's an unusual problem with the RCS file;
- * or the RCS file doesn't exist,
- * and we must read or we already have a lock elsewhere.
- */
- return 0;
-
- RCSpath = RCSbuf->string;
- sp = basefilename(RCSpath);
- l = sp - RCSpath;
- dirt = &dirtpname[waslocked];
- bufscpy(dirt, RCSpath);
- tp = dirt->string + l;
- x = rcssuffix(RCSpath);
-# if has_readlink
- if (!x) {
- error("symbolic link to non RCS file `%s'", RCSpath);
- errno = EINVAL;
- return 0;
- }
-# endif
- if (*sp == *x) {
- error("RCS pathname `%s' incompatible with suffix `%s'", sp, x);
- errno = EINVAL;
- return 0;
- }
- /* Create a lock filename that is a function of the RCS filename. */
- if (*x) {
- /*
- * The suffix is nonempty.
- * The lock filename is the first char of of the suffix,
- * followed by the RCS filename with last char removed. E.g.:
- * foo,v RCS filename with suffix ,v
- * ,foo, lock filename
- */
- *tp++ = *x;
- while (*sp)
- *tp++ = *sp++;
- *--tp = 0;
- } else {
- /*
- * The suffix is empty.
- * The lock filename is the RCS filename
- * with last char replaced by '_'.
- */
- while ((*tp++ = *sp++))
- continue;
- tp -= 2;
- if (*tp == '_') {
- error("RCS pathname `%s' ends with `%c'", RCSpath, *tp);
- errno = EINVAL;
- return 0;
- }
- *tp = '_';
- }
-
- sp = dirt->string;
-
- f = 0;
-
- /*
- * good news:
- * open(f, O_CREAT|O_EXCL|O_TRUNC|..., OPEN_CREAT_READONLY)
- * is atomic according to Posix 1003.1-1990.
- * bad news:
- * NFS ignores O_EXCL and doesn't comply with Posix 1003.1-1990.
- * good news:
- * (O_TRUNC,OPEN_CREAT_READONLY) normally guarantees atomicity
- * even with NFS.
- * bad news:
- * If you're root, (O_TRUNC,OPEN_CREAT_READONLY) doesn't
- * guarantee atomicity.
- * good news:
- * Root-over-the-wire NFS access is rare for security reasons.
- * This bug has never been reported in practice with RCS.
- * So we don't worry about this bug.
- *
- * An even rarer NFS bug can occur when clients retry requests.
- * This can happen in the usual case of NFS over UDP.
- * Suppose client A releases a lock by renaming ",f," to "f,v" at
- * about the same time that client B obtains a lock by creating ",f,",
- * and suppose A's first rename request is delayed, so A reissues it.
- * The sequence of events might be:
- * A sends rename(",f,", "f,v")
- * B sends create(",f,")
- * A sends retry of rename(",f,", "f,v")
- * server receives, does, and acknowledges A's first rename()
- * A receives acknowledgment, and its RCS program exits
- * server receives, does, and acknowledges B's create()
- * server receives, does, and acknowledges A's retry of rename()
- * This not only wrongly deletes B's lock, it removes the RCS file!
- * Most NFS implementations have idempotency caches that usually prevent
- * this scenario, but such caches are finite and can be overrun.
- * This problem afflicts not only RCS, which uses open() and rename()
- * to get and release locks; it also afflicts the traditional
- * Unix method of using link() and unlink() to get and release locks,
- * and the less traditional method of using mkdir() and rmdir().
- * There is no easy workaround.
- * Any new method based on lockf() seemingly would be incompatible with
- * the old methods; besides, lockf() is notoriously buggy under NFS.
- * Since this problem afflicts scads of Unix programs, but is so rare
- * that nobody seems to be worried about it, we won't worry either.
- */
-# if !open_can_creat
-# define create(f) creat(f, OPEN_CREAT_READONLY)
-# else
-# define create(f) open(f, OPEN_O_BINARY|OPEN_O_LOCK|OPEN_O_WRONLY|O_CREAT|O_EXCL|O_TRUNC, OPEN_CREAT_READONLY)
-# endif
-
- catchints();
- ignoreints();
-
- /*
- * Create a lock file for an RCS file. This should be atomic, i.e.
- * if two processes try it simultaneously, at most one should succeed.
- */
- seteid();
- fdesc = create(sp);
- fdescSafer = fdSafer(fdesc); /* Do it now; setrid might use stderr. */
- e = errno;
- setrid();
-
- if (0 <= fdesc)
- dirtpmaker[0] = effective;
-
- if (fdescSafer < 0) {
- if (e == EACCES && stat(sp,&statbuf) == 0)
- /* The RCS file is busy. */
- e = EEXIST;
- } else {
- e = ENOENT;
- if (exists) {
- f = Iopen(RCSpath, FOPEN_RB, status);
- e = errno;
- if (f && waslocked) {
- /* Discard the previous lock in favor of this one. */
- ORCSclose();
- seteid();
- r = un_link(lockname);
- e = errno;
- setrid();
- if (r != 0)
- enfaterror(e, lockname);
- bufscpy(&dirtpname[lockdirtp_index], sp);
- }
- }
- fdlock = fdescSafer;
- }
-
- restoreints();
-
- errno = e;
- return f;
-}
-
- void
-keepdirtemp(name)
- char const *name;
-/* Do not unlink name, either because it's not there any more,
- * or because it has already been unlinked.
- */
-{
- register int i;
- for (i=DIRTEMPNAMES; 0<=--i; )
- if (dirtpname[i].string == name) {
- dirtpmaker[i] = notmade;
- return;
- }
- faterror("keepdirtemp");
-}
-
- char const *
-makedirtemp(isworkfile)
- int isworkfile;
-/*
- * Create a unique pathname and store it into dirtpname.
- * Because of storage in tpnames, dirtempunlink() can unlink the file later.
- * Return a pointer to the pathname created.
- * If ISWORKFILE is 1, put it into the working file's directory;
- * if 0, put the unique file in RCSfile's directory.
- */
-{
- register char *tp, *np;
- register size_t dl;
- register struct buf *bn;
- register char const *name = isworkfile ? workname : RCSname;
-# if has_mktemp
- int fd;
-# endif
-
- dl = basefilename(name) - name;
- bn = &dirtpname[newRCSdirtp_index + isworkfile];
- bufalloc(bn,
-# if has_mktemp
- dl + 9
-# else
- strlen(name) + 3
-# endif
- );
- bufscpy(bn, name);
- np = tp = bn->string;
- tp += dl;
- *tp++ = '_';
- *tp++ = '0'+isworkfile;
- catchints();
-# if has_mktemp
- VOID strcpy(tp, "XXXXXX");
- fd = mkstemp(np);
- if (fd < 0 || !*np)
- faterror("can't make temporary pathname `%.*s_%cXXXXXX'",
- (int)dl, name, '0'+isworkfile
- );
- close(fd);
-# else
- /*
- * Posix 1003.1-1990 has no reliable way
- * to create a unique file in a named directory.
- * We fudge here. If the filename is abcde,
- * the temp filename is _Ncde where N is a digit.
- */
- name += dl;
- if (*name) name++;
- if (*name) name++;
- VOID strcpy(tp, name);
-# endif
- dirtpmaker[newRCSdirtp_index + isworkfile] = real;
- return np;
-}
-
- void
-dirtempunlink()
-/* Clean up makedirtemp() files. May be invoked by signal handler. */
-{
- register int i;
- enum maker m;
-
- for (i = DIRTEMPNAMES; 0 <= --i; )
- if ((m = dirtpmaker[i]) != notmade) {
- if (m == effective)
- seteid();
- VOID un_link(dirtpname[i].string);
- if (m == effective)
- setrid();
- dirtpmaker[i] = notmade;
- }
-}
-
-
- int
-#if has_prototypes
-chnamemod(
- FILE **fromp, char const *from, char const *to,
- int set_mode, mode_t mode, time_t mtime
-)
- /* The `#if has_prototypes' is needed because mode_t might promote to int. */
-#else
- chnamemod(fromp, from, to, set_mode, mode, mtime)
- FILE **fromp; char const *from,*to;
- int set_mode; mode_t mode; time_t mtime;
-#endif
-/*
- * Rename a file (with stream pointer *FROMP) from FROM to TO.
- * FROM already exists.
- * If 0 < SET_MODE, change the mode to MODE, before renaming if possible.
- * If MTIME is not -1, change its mtime to MTIME before renaming.
- * Close and clear *FROMP before renaming it.
- * Unlink TO if it already exists.
- * Return -1 on error (setting errno), 0 otherwise.
- */
-{
- mode_t mode_while_renaming = mode;
- int fchmod_set_mode = 0;
-
-# if bad_a_rename || bad_NFS_rename
- struct stat st;
- if (bad_NFS_rename || (bad_a_rename && set_mode <= 0)) {
- if (fstat(fileno(*fromp), &st) != 0)
- return -1;
- if (bad_a_rename && set_mode <= 0)
- mode = st.st_mode;
- }
-# endif
-
-# if bad_a_rename
- /*
- * There's a short window of inconsistency
- * during which the lock file is writable.
- */
- mode_while_renaming = mode|S_IWUSR;
- if (mode != mode_while_renaming)
- set_mode = 1;
-# endif
-
-# if has_fchmod
- if (0<set_mode && fchmod(fileno(*fromp),mode_while_renaming) == 0)
- fchmod_set_mode = set_mode;
-# endif
- /* If bad_chmod_close, we must close before chmod. */
- Ozclose(fromp);
- if (fchmod_set_mode<set_mode && chmod(from, mode_while_renaming) != 0)
- return -1;
-
- if (setmtime(from, mtime) != 0)
- return -1;
-
-# if !has_rename || bad_b_rename
- /*
- * There's a short window of inconsistency
- * during which TO does not exist.
- */
- if (un_link(to) != 0 && errno != ENOENT)
- return -1;
-# endif
-
-# if has_rename
- if (rename(from,to) != 0 && !(has_NFS && errno==ENOENT))
- return -1;
-# else
- if (do_link(from,to) != 0 || un_link(from) != 0)
- return -1;
-# endif
-
-# if bad_NFS_rename
- {
- /*
- * Check whether the rename falsely reported success.
- * A race condition can occur between the rename and the stat.
- */
- struct stat tostat;
- if (stat(to, &tostat) != 0)
- return -1;
- if (! same_file(st, tostat, 0)) {
- errno = EIO;
- return -1;
- }
- }
-# endif
-
-# if bad_a_rename
- if (0 < set_mode && chmod(to, mode) != 0)
- return -1;
-# endif
-
- return 0;
-}
-
- int
-setmtime(file, mtime)
- char const *file;
- time_t mtime;
-/* Set FILE's last modified time to MTIME, but do nothing if MTIME is -1. */
-{
- static struct utimbuf amtime; /* static so unused fields are zero */
- if (mtime == -1)
- return 0;
- amtime.actime = now();
- amtime.modtime = mtime;
- return utime(file, &amtime);
-}
-
-
-
- int
-findlock(delete, target)
- int delete;
- struct hshentry **target;
-/*
- * Find the first lock held by caller and return a pointer
- * to the locked delta; also removes the lock if DELETE.
- * If one lock, put it into *TARGET.
- * Return 0 for no locks, 1 for one, 2 for two or more.
- */
-{
- register struct rcslock *next, **trail, **found;
-
- found = 0;
- for (trail = &Locks; (next = *trail); trail = &next->nextlock)
- if (strcmp(getcaller(), next->login) == 0) {
- if (found) {
- rcserror("multiple revisions locked by %s; please specify one", getcaller());
- return 2;
- }
- found = trail;
- }
- if (!found)
- return 0;
- next = *found;
- *target = next->delta;
- if (delete) {
- next->delta->lockedby = 0;
- *found = next->nextlock;
- }
- return 1;
-}
-
- int
-addlock(delta, verbose)
- struct hshentry * delta;
- int verbose;
-/*
- * Add a lock held by caller to DELTA and yield 1 if successful.
- * Print an error message if verbose and yield -1 if no lock is added because
- * DELTA is locked by somebody other than caller.
- * Return 0 if the caller already holds the lock.
- */
-{
- register struct rcslock *next;
-
- for (next = Locks; next; next = next->nextlock)
- if (cmpnum(delta->num, next->delta->num) == 0)
- if (strcmp(getcaller(), next->login) == 0)
- return 0;
- else {
- if (verbose)
- rcserror("Revision %s is already locked by %s.",
- delta->num, next->login
- );
- return -1;
- }
- next = ftalloc(struct rcslock);
- delta->lockedby = next->login = getcaller();
- next->delta = delta;
- next->nextlock = Locks;
- Locks = next;
- return 1;
-}
-
-
- int
-addsymbol(num, name, rebind)
- char const *num, *name;
- int rebind;
-/*
- * Associate with revision NUM the new symbolic NAME.
- * If NAME already exists and REBIND is set, associate NAME with NUM;
- * otherwise, print an error message and return false;
- * Return -1 if unsuccessful, 0 if no change, 1 if change.
- */
-{
- register struct assoc *next;
-
- for (next = Symbols; next; next = next->nextassoc)
- if (strcmp(name, next->symbol) == 0)
- if (strcmp(next->num,num) == 0)
- return 0;
- else if (rebind) {
- next->num = num;
- return 1;
- } else {
- rcserror("symbolic name %s already bound to %s",
- name, next->num
- );
- return -1;
- }
- next = ftalloc(struct assoc);
- next->symbol = name;
- next->num = num;
- next->nextassoc = Symbols;
- Symbols = next;
- return 1;
-}
-
-
-
- char const *
-getcaller()
-/* Get the caller's login name. */
-{
-# if has_setuid
- return getusername(euid()!=ruid());
-# else
- return getusername(false);
-# endif
-}
-
-
- int
-checkaccesslist()
-/*
- * Return true if caller is the superuser, the owner of the
- * file, the access list is empty, or caller is on the access list.
- * Otherwise, print an error message and return false.
- */
-{
- register struct access const *next;
-
- if (!AccessList || myself(RCSstat.st_uid) || strcmp(getcaller(),"root")==0)
- return true;
-
- next = AccessList;
- do {
- if (strcmp(getcaller(), next->login) == 0)
- return true;
- } while ((next = next->nextaccess));
-
- rcserror("user %s not on the access list", getcaller());
- return false;
-}
-
-
- int
-dorewrite(lockflag, changed)
- int lockflag, changed;
-/*
- * Do nothing if LOCKFLAG is zero.
- * Prepare to rewrite an RCS file if CHANGED is positive.
- * Stop rewriting if CHANGED is zero, because there won't be any changes.
- * Fail if CHANGED is negative.
- * Return 0 on success, -1 on failure.
- */
-{
- int r = 0, e;
-
- if (lockflag)
- if (changed) {
- if (changed < 0)
- return -1;
- putadmin();
- puttree(Head, frewrite);
- aprintf(frewrite, "\n\n%s%c", Kdesc, nextc);
- foutptr = frewrite;
- } else {
-# if bad_creat0
- int nr = !!frewrite, ne = 0;
-# endif
- ORCSclose();
- seteid();
- ignoreints();
-# if bad_creat0
- if (nr) {
- nr = un_link(newRCSname);
- ne = errno;
- keepdirtemp(newRCSname);
- }
-# endif
- r = un_link(lockname);
- e = errno;
- keepdirtemp(lockname);
- restoreints();
- setrid();
- if (r != 0)
- enerror(e, lockname);
-# if bad_creat0
- if (nr != 0) {
- enerror(ne, newRCSname);
- r = -1;
- }
-# endif
- }
- return r;
-}
-
- int
-donerewrite(changed, newRCStime)
- int changed;
- time_t newRCStime;
-/*
- * Finish rewriting an RCS file if CHANGED is nonzero.
- * Set its mode if CHANGED is positive.
- * Set its modification time to NEWRCSTIME unless it is -1.
- * Return 0 on success, -1 on failure.
- */
-{
- int r = 0, e = 0;
-# if bad_creat0
- int lr, le;
-# endif
-
- if (changed && !nerror) {
- if (finptr) {
- fastcopy(finptr, frewrite);
- Izclose(&finptr);
- }
- if (1 < RCSstat.st_nlink)
- rcswarn("breaking hard link");
- aflush(frewrite);
- seteid();
- ignoreints();
- r = chnamemod(
- &frewrite, newRCSname, RCSname, changed,
- RCSstat.st_mode & (mode_t)~(S_IWUSR|S_IWGRP|S_IWOTH),
- newRCStime
- );
- e = errno;
- keepdirtemp(newRCSname);
-# if bad_creat0
- lr = un_link(lockname);
- le = errno;
- keepdirtemp(lockname);
-# endif
- restoreints();
- setrid();
- if (r != 0) {
- enerror(e, RCSname);
- error("saved in %s", newRCSname);
- }
-# if bad_creat0
- if (lr != 0) {
- enerror(le, lockname);
- r = -1;
- }
-# endif
- }
- return r;
-}
-
- void
-ORCSclose()
-{
- if (0 <= fdlock) {
- if (close(fdlock) != 0)
- efaterror(lockname);
- fdlock = -1;
- }
- Ozclose(&frewrite);
-}
-
- void
-ORCSerror()
-/*
-* Like ORCSclose, except we are cleaning up after an interrupt or fatal error.
-* Do not report errors, since this may loop. This is needed only because
-* some brain-damaged hosts (e.g. OS/2) cannot unlink files that are open, and
-* some nearly-Posix hosts (e.g. NFS) work better if the files are closed first.
-* This isn't a completely reliable away to work around brain-damaged hosts,
-* because of the gap between actual file opening and setting frewrite etc.,
-* but it's better than nothing.
-*/
-{
- if (0 <= fdlock)
- VOID close(fdlock);
- if (frewrite)
- /* Avoid fclose, since stdio may not be reentrant. */
- VOID close(fileno(frewrite));
-}
diff --git a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsfcmp.c b/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsfcmp.c
deleted file mode 100644
index ef05290..0000000
--- a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsfcmp.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,354 +0,0 @@
-/* Compare working files, ignoring RCS keyword strings. */
-
-/*****************************************************************************
- * rcsfcmp()
- * Testprogram: define FCMPTEST
- *****************************************************************************
- */
-
-/* Copyright 1982, 1988, 1989 Walter Tichy
- Copyright 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995 Paul Eggert
- Distributed under license by the Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-
-This file is part of RCS.
-
-RCS is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
-it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
-any later version.
-
-RCS is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
-GNU General Public License for more details.
-
-You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-along with RCS; see the file COPYING.
-If not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
-59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
-
-Report problems and direct all questions to:
-
- rcs-bugs@cs.purdue.edu
-
-*/
-
-
-
-
-
-/*
- * Revision 5.14 1995/06/16 06:19:24 eggert
- * Update FSF address.
- *
- * Revision 5.13 1995/06/01 16:23:43 eggert
- * (rcsfcmp): Add -kb support.
- *
- * Revision 5.12 1994/03/17 14:05:48 eggert
- * Normally calculate the $Log prefix from context, not from RCS file.
- * Calculate line numbers correctly even if the $Log prefix contains newlines.
- * Remove lint.
- *
- * Revision 5.11 1993/11/03 17:42:27 eggert
- * Fix yet another off-by-one error when comparing Log string expansions.
- *
- * Revision 5.10 1992/07/28 16:12:44 eggert
- * Statement macro names now end in _.
- *
- * Revision 5.9 1991/10/07 17:32:46 eggert
- * Count log lines correctly.
- *
- * Revision 5.8 1991/08/19 03:13:55 eggert
- * Tune.
- *
- * Revision 5.7 1991/04/21 11:58:22 eggert
- * Fix errno bug. Add MS-DOS support.
- *
- * Revision 5.6 1991/02/28 19:18:47 eggert
- * Open work file at most once.
- *
- * Revision 5.5 1990/11/27 09:26:05 eggert
- * Fix comment leader bug.
- *
- * Revision 5.4 1990/11/01 05:03:42 eggert
- * Permit arbitrary data in logs and comment leaders.
- *
- * Revision 5.3 1990/09/11 02:41:15 eggert
- * Don't ignore differences inside keyword strings if -ko is set.
- *
- * Revision 5.1 1990/08/29 07:13:58 eggert
- * Clean old log messages too.
- *
- * Revision 5.0 1990/08/22 08:12:49 eggert
- * Don't append "checked in with -k by " log to logs,
- * so that checking in a program with -k doesn't change it.
- * Ansify and Posixate. Remove lint.
- *
- * Revision 4.5 89/05/01 15:12:42 narten
- * changed copyright header to reflect current distribution rules
- *
- * Revision 4.4 88/08/09 19:12:50 eggert
- * Shrink stdio code size.
- *
- * Revision 4.3 87/12/18 11:40:02 narten
- * lint cleanups (Guy Harris)
- *
- * Revision 4.2 87/10/18 10:33:06 narten
- * updting version number. Changes relative to 1.1 actually relative to
- * 4.1
- *
- * Revision 1.2 87/03/27 14:22:19 jenkins
- * Port to suns
- *
- * Revision 4.1 83/05/10 16:24:04 wft
- * Marker matching now uses trymatch(). Marker pattern is now
- * checked precisely.
- *
- * Revision 3.1 82/12/04 13:21:40 wft
- * Initial revision.
- *
- */
-
-/*
-#define FCMPTEST
-*/
-/* Testprogram; prints out whether two files are identical,
- * except for keywords
- */
-
-#include "rcsbase.h"
-
-libId(fcmpId, "$FreeBSD$")
-
- static int discardkeyval P((int,RILE*));
- static int
-discardkeyval(c, f)
- register int c;
- register RILE *f;
-{
- for (;;)
- switch (c) {
- case KDELIM:
- case '\n':
- return c;
- default:
- Igeteof_(f, c, return EOF;)
- break;
- }
-}
-
- int
-rcsfcmp(xfp, xstatp, uname, delta)
- register RILE *xfp;
- struct stat const *xstatp;
- char const *uname;
- struct hshentry const *delta;
-/* Compare the files xfp and uname. Return zero
- * if xfp has the same contents as uname and neither has keywords,
- * otherwise -1 if they are the same ignoring keyword values,
- * and 1 if they differ even ignoring
- * keyword values. For the LOG-keyword, rcsfcmp skips the log message
- * given by the parameter delta in xfp. Thus, rcsfcmp returns nonpositive
- * if xfp contains the same as uname, with the keywords expanded.
- * Implementation: character-by-character comparison until $ is found.
- * If a $ is found, read in the marker keywords; if they are real keywords
- * and identical, read in keyword value. If value is terminated properly,
- * disregard it and optionally skip log message; otherwise, compare value.
- */
-{
- register int xc, uc;
- char xkeyword[keylength+2];
- int eqkeyvals;
- register RILE *ufp;
- register int xeof, ueof;
- register char * tp;
- register char const *sp;
- register size_t leaderlen;
- int result;
- enum markers match1;
- struct stat ustat;
-
- if (!(ufp = Iopen(uname, FOPEN_R_WORK, &ustat))) {
- efaterror(uname);
- }
- xeof = ueof = false;
- if (MIN_UNEXPAND <= Expand) {
- if (!(result = xstatp->st_size!=ustat.st_size)) {
-# if large_memory && maps_memory
- result = !!memcmp(xfp->base,ufp->base,(size_t)xstatp->st_size);
-# else
- for (;;) {
- /* get the next characters */
- Igeteof_(xfp, xc, xeof=true;)
- Igeteof_(ufp, uc, ueof=true;)
- if (xeof | ueof)
- goto eof;
- if (xc != uc)
- goto return1;
- }
-# endif
- }
- } else {
- xc = 0;
- uc = 0; /* Keep lint happy. */
- leaderlen = 0;
- result = 0;
-
- for (;;) {
- if (xc != KDELIM) {
- /* get the next characters */
- Igeteof_(xfp, xc, xeof=true;)
- Igeteof_(ufp, uc, ueof=true;)
- if (xeof | ueof)
- goto eof;
- } else {
- /* try to get both keywords */
- tp = xkeyword;
- for (;;) {
- Igeteof_(xfp, xc, xeof=true;)
- Igeteof_(ufp, uc, ueof=true;)
- if (xeof | ueof)
- goto eof;
- if (xc != uc)
- break;
- switch (xc) {
- default:
- if (xkeyword+keylength <= tp)
- break;
- *tp++ = xc;
- continue;
- case '\n': case KDELIM: case VDELIM:
- break;
- }
- break;
- }
- if (
- (xc==KDELIM || xc==VDELIM) && (uc==KDELIM || uc==VDELIM) &&
- (*tp = xc, (match1 = trymatch(xkeyword)) != Nomatch)
- ) {
-#ifdef FCMPTEST
- VOID printf("found common keyword %s\n",xkeyword);
-#endif
- result = -1;
- for (;;) {
- if (xc != uc) {
- xc = discardkeyval(xc, xfp);
- uc = discardkeyval(uc, ufp);
- if ((xeof = xc==EOF) | (ueof = uc==EOF))
- goto eof;
- eqkeyvals = false;
- break;
- }
- switch (xc) {
- default:
- Igeteof_(xfp, xc, xeof=true;)
- Igeteof_(ufp, uc, ueof=true;)
- if (xeof | ueof)
- goto eof;
- continue;
-
- case '\n': case KDELIM:
- eqkeyvals = true;
- break;
- }
- break;
- }
- if (xc != uc)
- goto return1;
- if (xc==KDELIM) {
- /* Skip closing KDELIM. */
- Igeteof_(xfp, xc, xeof=true;)
- Igeteof_(ufp, uc, ueof=true;)
- if (xeof | ueof)
- goto eof;
- /* if the keyword is LOG, also skip the log message in xfp*/
- if (match1==Log) {
- /* first, compute the number of line feeds in log msg */
- int lncnt;
- size_t ls, ccnt;
- sp = delta->log.string;
- ls = delta->log.size;
- if (ls<sizeof(ciklog)-1 || memcmp(sp,ciklog,sizeof(ciklog)-1)) {
- /*
- * This log message was inserted. Skip its header.
- * The number of newlines to skip is
- * 1 + (C+1)*(1+L+1), where C is the number of newlines
- * in the comment leader, and L is the number of
- * newlines in the log string.
- */
- int c1 = 1;
- for (ccnt=Comment.size; ccnt--; )
- c1 += Comment.string[ccnt] == '\n';
- lncnt = 2*c1 + 1;
- while (ls--) if (*sp++=='\n') lncnt += c1;
- for (;;) {
- if (xc=='\n')
- if(--lncnt==0) break;
- Igeteof_(xfp, xc, goto returnresult;)
- }
- /* skip last comment leader */
- /* Can't just skip another line here, because there may be */
- /* additional characters on the line (after the Log....$) */
- ccnt = RCSversion<VERSION(5) ? Comment.size : leaderlen;
- do {
- Igeteof_(xfp, xc, goto returnresult;)
- /*
- * Read to the end of the comment leader or '\n',
- * whatever comes first, because the leader's
- * trailing white space was probably stripped.
- */
- } while (ccnt-- && (xc!='\n' || --c1));
- }
- }
- } else {
- /* both end in the same character, but not a KDELIM */
- /* must compare string values.*/
-#ifdef FCMPTEST
- VOID printf("non-terminated keywords %s, potentially different values\n",xkeyword);
-#endif
- if (!eqkeyvals)
- goto return1;
- }
- }
- }
- if (xc != uc)
- goto return1;
- if (xc == '\n')
- leaderlen = 0;
- else
- leaderlen++;
- }
- }
-
- eof:
- if (xeof==ueof)
- goto returnresult;
- return1:
- result = 1;
- returnresult:
- Ifclose(ufp);
- return result;
-}
-
-
-
-#ifdef FCMPTEST
-
-char const cmdid[] = "rcsfcmp";
-
-main(argc, argv)
-int argc; char *argv[];
-/* first argument: comment leader; 2nd: log message, 3rd: expanded file,
- * 4th: unexpanded file
- */
-{ struct hshentry delta;
-
- Comment.string = argv[1];
- Comment.size = strlen(argv[1]);
- delta.log.string = argv[2];
- delta.log.size = strlen(argv[2]);
- if (rcsfcmp(Iopen(argv[3], FOPEN_R_WORK, (struct stat*)0), argv[4], &delta))
- VOID printf("files are the same\n");
- else VOID printf("files are different\n");
-}
-#endif
diff --git a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsfnms.c b/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsfnms.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 00caec5..0000000
--- a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsfnms.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,1132 +0,0 @@
-/* RCS filename and pathname handling */
-
-/****************************************************************************
- * creation and deletion of /tmp temporaries
- * pairing of RCS pathnames and working pathnames.
- * Testprogram: define PAIRTEST
- ****************************************************************************
- */
-
-/* Copyright 1982, 1988, 1989 Walter Tichy
- Copyright 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995 Paul Eggert
- Distributed under license by the Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-
-This file is part of RCS.
-
-RCS is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
-it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
-any later version.
-
-RCS is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
-GNU General Public License for more details.
-
-You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-along with RCS; see the file COPYING.
-If not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
-59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
-
-Report problems and direct all questions to:
-
- rcs-bugs@cs.purdue.edu
-
-*/
-
-
-
-
-/*
- * Revision 5.16 1995/06/16 06:19:24 eggert
- * Update FSF address.
- *
- * Revision 5.15 1995/06/01 16:23:43 eggert
- * (basefilename): Renamed from basename to avoid collisions.
- * (dirlen): Remove (for similar reasons).
- * (rcsreadopen): Open with FOPEN_RB.
- * (SLASHSLASH_is_SLASH): Default is 0.
- * (getcwd): Work around bad_wait_if_SIGCHLD_ignored bug.
- *
- * Revision 5.14 1994/03/17 14:05:48 eggert
- * Strip trailing SLASHes from TMPDIR; some systems need this. Remove lint.
- *
- * Revision 5.13 1993/11/03 17:42:27 eggert
- * Determine whether a file name is too long indirectly,
- * by examining inode numbers, instead of trying to use operating system
- * primitives like pathconf, which are not trustworthy in general.
- * File names may now hold white space or $.
- * Do not flatten ../X in pathnames; that may yield wrong answer for symlinks.
- * Add getabsname hook. Improve quality of diagnostics.
- *
- * Revision 5.12 1992/07/28 16:12:44 eggert
- * Add .sty. .pl now implies Perl, not Prolog. Fix fdlock initialization bug.
- * Check that $PWD is really ".". Be consistent about pathnames vs filenames.
- *
- * Revision 5.11 1992/02/17 23:02:25 eggert
- * `a/RCS/b/c' is now an RCS file with an empty extension, not just `a/b/RCS/c'.
- *
- * Revision 5.10 1992/01/24 18:44:19 eggert
- * Fix bug: Expand and Ignored weren't reinitialized.
- * Avoid `char const c=ch;' compiler bug.
- * Add support for bad_creat0.
- *
- * Revision 5.9 1992/01/06 02:42:34 eggert
- * Shorten long (>31 chars) name.
- * while (E) ; -> while (E) continue;
- *
- * Revision 5.8 1991/09/24 00:28:40 eggert
- * Don't export bindex().
- *
- * Revision 5.7 1991/08/19 03:13:55 eggert
- * Fix messages when rcswriteopen fails.
- * Look in $TMP and $TEMP if $TMPDIR isn't set. Tune.
- *
- * Revision 5.6 1991/04/21 11:58:23 eggert
- * Fix errno bugs. Add -x, RCSINIT, MS-DOS support.
- *
- * Revision 5.5 1991/02/26 17:48:38 eggert
- * Fix setuid bug. Support new link behavior.
- * Define more portable getcwd().
- *
- * Revision 5.4 1990/11/01 05:03:43 eggert
- * Permit arbitrary data in comment leaders.
- *
- * Revision 5.3 1990/09/14 22:56:16 hammer
- * added more filename extensions and their comment leaders
- *
- * Revision 5.2 1990/09/04 08:02:23 eggert
- * Fix typo when !RCSSEP.
- *
- * Revision 5.1 1990/08/29 07:13:59 eggert
- * Work around buggy compilers with defective argument promotion.
- *
- * Revision 5.0 1990/08/22 08:12:50 eggert
- * Ignore signals when manipulating the semaphore file.
- * Modernize list of filename extensions.
- * Permit paths of arbitrary length. Beware filenames beginning with "-".
- * Remove compile-time limits; use malloc instead.
- * Permit dates past 1999/12/31. Make lock and temp files faster and safer.
- * Ansify and Posixate.
- * Don't use access(). Fix test for non-regular files. Tune.
- *
- * Revision 4.8 89/05/01 15:09:41 narten
- * changed getwd to not stat empty directories.
- *
- * Revision 4.7 88/08/09 19:12:53 eggert
- * Fix troff macro comment leader bug; add Prolog; allow cc -R; remove lint.
- *
- * Revision 4.6 87/12/18 11:40:23 narten
- * additional file types added from 4.3 BSD version, and SPARC assembler
- * comment character added. Also, more lint cleanups. (Guy Harris)
- *
- * Revision 4.5 87/10/18 10:34:16 narten
- * Updating version numbers. Changes relative to 1.1 actually relative
- * to verion 4.3
- *
- * Revision 1.3 87/03/27 14:22:21 jenkins
- * Port to suns
- *
- * Revision 1.2 85/06/26 07:34:28 svb
- * Comment leader '% ' for '*.tex' files added.
- *
- * Revision 4.3 83/12/15 12:26:48 wft
- * Added check for KDELIM in filenames to pairfilenames().
- *
- * Revision 4.2 83/12/02 22:47:45 wft
- * Added csh, red, and sl filename suffixes.
- *
- * Revision 4.1 83/05/11 16:23:39 wft
- * Added initialization of Dbranch to InitAdmin(). Canged pairfilenames():
- * 1. added copying of path from workfile to RCS file, if RCS file is omitted;
- * 2. added getting the file status of RCS and working files;
- * 3. added ignoring of directories.
- *
- * Revision 3.7 83/05/11 15:01:58 wft
- * Added comtable[] which pairs filename suffixes with comment leaders;
- * updated InitAdmin() accordingly.
- *
- * Revision 3.6 83/04/05 14:47:36 wft
- * fixed Suffix in InitAdmin().
- *
- * Revision 3.5 83/01/17 18:01:04 wft
- * Added getwd() and rename(); these can be removed by defining
- * V4_2BSD, since they are not needed in 4.2 bsd.
- * Changed sys/param.h to sys/types.h.
- *
- * Revision 3.4 82/12/08 21:55:20 wft
- * removed unused variable.
- *
- * Revision 3.3 82/11/28 20:31:37 wft
- * Changed mktempfile() to store the generated filenames.
- * Changed getfullRCSname() to store the file and pathname, and to
- * delete leading "../" and "./".
- *
- * Revision 3.2 82/11/12 14:29:40 wft
- * changed pairfilenames() to handle file.sfx,v; also deleted checkpathnosfx(),
- * checksuffix(), checkfullpath(). Semaphore name generation updated.
- * mktempfile() now checks for nil path; freefilename initialized properly.
- * Added Suffix .h to InitAdmin. Added testprogram PAIRTEST.
- * Moved rmsema, trysema, trydiraccess, getfullRCSname from rcsutil.c to here.
- *
- * Revision 3.1 82/10/18 14:51:28 wft
- * InitAdmin() now initializes StrictLocks=STRICT_LOCKING (def. in rcsbase.h).
- * renamed checkpath() to checkfullpath().
- */
-
-
-#include "rcsbase.h"
-
-libId(fnmsId, "$FreeBSD$")
-
-static char const *bindex P((char const*,int));
-static int fin2open P((char const*, size_t, char const*, size_t, char const*, size_t, RILE*(*)P((struct buf*,struct stat*,int)), int));
-static int finopen P((RILE*(*)P((struct buf*,struct stat*,int)), int));
-static int suffix_matches P((char const*,char const*));
-static size_t dir_useful_len P((char const*));
-static size_t suffixlen P((char const*));
-static void InitAdmin P((void));
-
-char const *RCSname;
-char *workname;
-int fdlock;
-FILE *workstdout;
-struct stat RCSstat;
-char const *suffixes;
-
-static char const rcsdir[] = "RCS";
-#define rcslen (sizeof(rcsdir)-1)
-
-static struct buf RCSbuf, RCSb;
-static int RCSerrno;
-
-
-/* Temp names to be unlinked when done, if they are not 0. */
-#define TEMPNAMES 5 /* must be at least DIRTEMPNAMES (see rcsedit.c) */
-static char *volatile tpnames[TEMPNAMES];
-
-
-struct compair {
- char const *suffix, *comlead;
-};
-
-/*
-* This table is present only for backwards compatibility.
-* Normally we ignore this table, and use the prefix of the `$Log' line instead.
-*/
-static struct compair const comtable[] = {
- { "a" , "-- " }, /* Ada */
- { "ada" , "-- " },
- { "adb" , "-- " },
- { "ads" , "-- " },
- { "asm" , ";; " }, /* assembler (MS-DOS) */
- { "bat" , ":: " }, /* batch (MS-DOS) */
- { "body", "-- " }, /* Ada */
- { "c" , " * " }, /* C */
- { "c++" , "// " }, /* C++ in all its infinite guises */
- { "cc" , "// " },
- { "cpp" , "// " },
- { "cxx" , "// " },
- { "cl" , ";;; "}, /* Common Lisp */
- { "cmd" , ":: " }, /* command (OS/2) */
- { "cmf" , "c " }, /* CM Fortran */
- { "cs" , " * " }, /* C* */
- { "el" , "; " }, /* Emacs Lisp */
- { "f" , "c " }, /* Fortran */
- { "for" , "c " },
- { "h" , " * " }, /* C-header */
- { "hpp" , "// " }, /* C++ header */
- { "hxx" , "// " },
- { "l" , " * " }, /* lex (NOTE: franzlisp disagrees) */
- { "lisp", ";;; "}, /* Lucid Lisp */
- { "lsp" , ";; " }, /* Microsoft Lisp */
- { "m" , "// " }, /* Objective C */
- { "mac" , ";; " }, /* macro (DEC-10, MS-DOS, PDP-11, VMS, etc) */
- { "me" , ".\\\" "}, /* troff -me */
- { "ml" , "; " }, /* mocklisp */
- { "mm" , ".\\\" "}, /* troff -mm */
- { "ms" , ".\\\" "}, /* troff -ms */
- { "p" , " * " }, /* Pascal */
- { "pas" , " * " },
- { "ps" , "% " }, /* PostScript */
- { "spec", "-- " }, /* Ada */
- { "sty" , "% " }, /* LaTeX style */
- { "tex" , "% " }, /* TeX */
- { "y" , " * " }, /* yacc */
- { 0 , "# " } /* default for unknown suffix; must be last */
-};
-
-#if has_mktemp
- static char const *tmp P((void));
- static char const *
-tmp()
-/* Yield the name of the tmp directory. */
-{
- static char const *s;
- if (!s
- && !(s = cgetenv("TMPDIR")) /* Unix tradition */
- && !(s = cgetenv("TMP")) /* DOS tradition */
- && !(s = cgetenv("TEMP")) /* another DOS tradition */
- )
- s = TMPDIR;
- return s;
-}
-#endif
-
- char const *
-maketemp(n)
- int n;
-/* Create a unique pathname using n and the process id and store it
- * into the nth slot in tpnames.
- * Because of storage in tpnames, tempunlink() can unlink the file later.
- * Return a pointer to the pathname created.
- */
-{
- char *p;
- char const *t = tpnames[n];
-# if has_mktemp
- int fd;
-# endif
-
- if (t)
- return t;
-
- catchints();
- {
-# if has_mktemp
- char const *tp = tmp();
- size_t tplen = dir_useful_len(tp);
- p = testalloc(tplen + 10);
- VOID sprintf(p, "%.*s%cT%cXXXXXX", (int)tplen, tp, SLASH, '0'+n);
- fd = mkstemp(p);
- if (fd < 0 || !*p)
- faterror("can't make temporary pathname `%.*s%cT%cXXXXXX'",
- (int)tplen, tp, SLASH, '0'+n
- );
- close(fd);
-# else
- static char tpnamebuf[TEMPNAMES][L_tmpnam];
- p = tpnamebuf[n];
- if (!tmpnam(p) || !*p)
-# ifdef P_tmpdir
- faterror("can't make temporary pathname `%s...'",P_tmpdir);
-# else
- faterror("can't make temporary pathname");
-# endif
-# endif
- }
-
- tpnames[n] = p;
- return p;
-}
-
- void
-tempunlink()
-/* Clean up maketemp() files. May be invoked by signal handler.
- */
-{
- register int i;
- register char *p;
-
- for (i = TEMPNAMES; 0 <= --i; )
- if ((p = tpnames[i])) {
- VOID unlink(p);
- /*
- * We would tfree(p) here,
- * but this might dump core if we're handing a signal.
- * We're about to exit anyway, so we won't bother.
- */
- tpnames[i] = 0;
- }
-}
-
-
- static char const *
-bindex(sp, c)
- register char const *sp;
- register int c;
-/* Function: Finds the last occurrence of character c in string sp
- * and returns a pointer to the character just beyond it. If the
- * character doesn't occur in the string, sp is returned.
- */
-{
- register char const *r;
- r = sp;
- while (*sp) {
- if (*sp++ == c) r=sp;
- }
- return r;
-}
-
-
-
- static int
-suffix_matches(suffix, pattern)
- register char const *suffix, *pattern;
-{
- register int c;
- if (!pattern)
- return true;
- for (;;)
- switch (*suffix++ - (c = *pattern++)) {
- case 0:
- if (!c)
- return true;
- break;
-
- case 'A'-'a':
- if (ctab[c] == Letter)
- break;
- /* fall into */
- default:
- return false;
- }
-}
-
-
- static void
-InitAdmin()
-/* function: initializes an admin node */
-{
- register char const *Suffix;
- register int i;
-
- Head=0; Dbranch=0; AccessList=0; Symbols=0; Locks=0;
- StrictLocks=STRICT_LOCKING;
-
- /* guess the comment leader from the suffix*/
- Suffix = bindex(workname, '.');
- if (Suffix==workname) Suffix= ""; /* empty suffix; will get default*/
- for (i=0; !suffix_matches(Suffix,comtable[i].suffix); i++)
- continue;
- Comment.string = comtable[i].comlead;
- Comment.size = strlen(comtable[i].comlead);
- Expand = KEYVAL_EXPAND;
- clear_buf(&Ignored);
- Lexinit(); /* note: if !finptr, reads nothing; only initializes */
-}
-
-
-
- void
-bufalloc(b, size)
- register struct buf *b;
- size_t size;
-/* Ensure *B is a name buffer of at least SIZE bytes.
- * *B's old contents can be freed; *B's new contents are undefined.
- */
-{
- if (b->size < size) {
- if (b->size)
- tfree(b->string);
- else
- b->size = sizeof(malloc_type);
- while (b->size < size)
- b->size <<= 1;
- b->string = tnalloc(char, b->size);
- }
-}
-
- void
-bufrealloc(b, size)
- register struct buf *b;
- size_t size;
-/* like bufalloc, except *B's old contents, if any, are preserved */
-{
- if (b->size < size) {
- if (!b->size)
- bufalloc(b, size);
- else {
- while ((b->size <<= 1) < size)
- continue;
- b->string = trealloc(char, b->string, b->size);
- }
- }
-}
-
- void
-bufautoend(b)
- struct buf *b;
-/* Free an auto buffer at block exit. */
-{
- if (b->size)
- tfree(b->string);
-}
-
- struct cbuf
-bufremember(b, s)
- struct buf *b;
- size_t s;
-/*
- * Free the buffer B with used size S.
- * Yield a cbuf with identical contents.
- * The cbuf will be reclaimed when this input file is finished.
- */
-{
- struct cbuf cb;
-
- if ((cb.size = s))
- cb.string = fremember(trealloc(char, b->string, s));
- else {
- bufautoend(b); /* not really auto */
- cb.string = "";
- }
- return cb;
-}
-
- char *
-bufenlarge(b, alim)
- register struct buf *b;
- char const **alim;
-/* Make *B larger. Set *ALIM to its new limit, and yield the relocated value
- * of its old limit.
- */
-{
- size_t s = b->size;
- bufrealloc(b, s + 1);
- *alim = b->string + b->size;
- return b->string + s;
-}
-
- void
-bufscat(b, s)
- struct buf *b;
- char const *s;
-/* Concatenate S to B's end. */
-{
- size_t blen = b->string ? strlen(b->string) : 0;
- bufrealloc(b, blen+strlen(s)+1);
- VOID strcpy(b->string+blen, s);
-}
-
- void
-bufscpy(b, s)
- struct buf *b;
- char const *s;
-/* Copy S into B. */
-{
- bufalloc(b, strlen(s)+1);
- VOID strcpy(b->string, s);
-}
-
-
- char const *
-basefilename(p)
- char const *p;
-/* Yield the address of the base filename of the pathname P. */
-{
- register char const *b = p, *q = p;
- for (;;)
- switch (*q++) {
- case SLASHes: b = q; break;
- case 0: return b;
- }
-}
-
-
- static size_t
-suffixlen(x)
- char const *x;
-/* Yield the length of X, an RCS pathname suffix. */
-{
- register char const *p;
-
- p = x;
- for (;;)
- switch (*p) {
- case 0: case SLASHes:
- return p - x;
-
- default:
- ++p;
- continue;
- }
-}
-
- char const *
-rcssuffix(name)
- char const *name;
-/* Yield the suffix of NAME if it is an RCS pathname, 0 otherwise. */
-{
- char const *x, *p, *nz;
- size_t nl, xl;
-
- nl = strlen(name);
- nz = name + nl;
- x = suffixes;
- do {
- if ((xl = suffixlen(x))) {
- if (xl <= nl && memcmp(p = nz-xl, x, xl) == 0)
- return p;
- } else
- for (p = name; p < nz - rcslen; p++)
- if (
- isSLASH(p[rcslen])
- && (p==name || isSLASH(p[-1]))
- && memcmp(p, rcsdir, rcslen) == 0
- )
- return nz;
- x += xl;
- } while (*x++);
- return 0;
-}
-
- /*ARGSUSED*/ RILE *
-rcsreadopen(RCSpath, status, mustread)
- struct buf *RCSpath;
- struct stat *status;
- int mustread;
-/* Open RCSPATH for reading and yield its FILE* descriptor.
- * If successful, set *STATUS to its status.
- * Pass this routine to pairnames() for read-only access to the file. */
-{
- return Iopen(RCSpath->string, FOPEN_RB, status);
-}
-
- static int
-finopen(rcsopen, mustread)
- RILE *(*rcsopen)P((struct buf*,struct stat*,int));
- int mustread;
-/*
- * Use RCSOPEN to open an RCS file; MUSTREAD is set if the file must be read.
- * Set finptr to the result and yield true if successful.
- * RCSb holds the file's name.
- * Set RCSbuf to the best RCS name found so far, and RCSerrno to its errno.
- * Yield true if successful or if an unusual failure.
- */
-{
- int interesting, preferold;
-
- /*
- * We prefer an old name to that of a nonexisting new RCS file,
- * unless we tried locking the old name and failed.
- */
- preferold = RCSbuf.string[0] && (mustread||0<=fdlock);
-
- finptr = (*rcsopen)(&RCSb, &RCSstat, mustread);
- interesting = finptr || errno!=ENOENT;
- if (interesting || !preferold) {
- /* Use the new name. */
- RCSerrno = errno;
- bufscpy(&RCSbuf, RCSb.string);
- }
- return interesting;
-}
-
- static int
-fin2open(d, dlen, base, baselen, x, xlen, rcsopen, mustread)
- char const *d, *base, *x;
- size_t dlen, baselen, xlen;
- RILE *(*rcsopen)P((struct buf*,struct stat*,int));
- int mustread;
-/*
- * D is a directory name with length DLEN (including trailing slash).
- * BASE is a filename with length BASELEN.
- * X is an RCS pathname suffix with length XLEN.
- * Use RCSOPEN to open an RCS file; MUSTREAD is set if the file must be read.
- * Yield true if successful.
- * Try dRCS/basex first; if that fails and x is nonempty, try dbasex.
- * Put these potential names in RCSb.
- * Set RCSbuf to the best RCS name found so far, and RCSerrno to its errno.
- * Yield true if successful or if an unusual failure.
- */
-{
- register char *p;
-
- bufalloc(&RCSb, dlen + rcslen + 1 + baselen + xlen + 1);
-
- /* Try dRCS/basex. */
- VOID memcpy(p = RCSb.string, d, dlen);
- VOID memcpy(p += dlen, rcsdir, rcslen);
- p += rcslen;
- *p++ = SLASH;
- VOID memcpy(p, base, baselen);
- VOID memcpy(p += baselen, x, xlen);
- p[xlen] = 0;
- if (xlen) {
- if (finopen(rcsopen, mustread))
- return true;
-
- /* Try dbasex. */
- /* Start from scratch, because finopen() may have changed RCSb. */
- VOID memcpy(p = RCSb.string, d, dlen);
- VOID memcpy(p += dlen, base, baselen);
- VOID memcpy(p += baselen, x, xlen);
- p[xlen] = 0;
- }
- return finopen(rcsopen, mustread);
-}
-
- int
-pairnames(argc, argv, rcsopen, mustread, quiet)
- int argc;
- char **argv;
- RILE *(*rcsopen)P((struct buf*,struct stat*,int));
- int mustread, quiet;
-/*
- * Pair the pathnames pointed to by argv; argc indicates
- * how many there are.
- * Place a pointer to the RCS pathname into RCSname,
- * and a pointer to the pathname of the working file into workname.
- * If both are given, and workstdout
- * is set, a warning is printed.
- *
- * If the RCS file exists, places its status into RCSstat.
- *
- * If the RCS file exists, it is RCSOPENed for reading, the file pointer
- * is placed into finptr, and the admin-node is read in; returns 1.
- * If the RCS file does not exist and MUSTREAD,
- * print an error unless QUIET and return 0.
- * Otherwise, initialize the admin node and return -1.
- *
- * 0 is returned on all errors, e.g. files that are not regular files.
- */
-{
- static struct buf tempbuf;
-
- register char *p, *arg, *RCS1;
- char const *base, *RCSbase, *x;
- int paired;
- size_t arglen, dlen, baselen, xlen;
-
- fdlock = -1;
-
- if (!(arg = *argv)) return 0; /* already paired pathname */
- if (*arg == '-') {
- error("%s option is ignored after pathnames", arg);
- return 0;
- }
-
- base = basefilename(arg);
- paired = false;
-
- /* first check suffix to see whether it is an RCS file or not */
- if ((x = rcssuffix(arg)))
- {
- /* RCS pathname given */
- RCS1 = arg;
- RCSbase = base;
- baselen = x - base;
- if (
- 1 < argc &&
- !rcssuffix(workname = p = argv[1]) &&
- baselen <= (arglen = strlen(p)) &&
- ((p+=arglen-baselen) == workname || isSLASH(p[-1])) &&
- memcmp(base, p, baselen) == 0
- ) {
- argv[1] = 0;
- paired = true;
- } else {
- bufscpy(&tempbuf, base);
- workname = p = tempbuf.string;
- p[baselen] = 0;
- }
- } else {
- /* working file given; now try to find RCS file */
- workname = arg;
- baselen = strlen(base);
- /* Derive RCS pathname. */
- if (
- 1 < argc &&
- (x = rcssuffix(RCS1 = argv[1])) &&
- baselen <= x - RCS1 &&
- ((RCSbase=x-baselen)==RCS1 || isSLASH(RCSbase[-1])) &&
- memcmp(base, RCSbase, baselen) == 0
- ) {
- argv[1] = 0;
- paired = true;
- } else
- RCSbase = RCS1 = 0;
- }
- /* Now we have a (tentative) RCS pathname in RCS1 and workname. */
- /* Second, try to find the right RCS file */
- if (RCSbase!=RCS1) {
- /* a path for RCSfile is given; single RCS file to look for */
- bufscpy(&RCSbuf, RCS1);
- finptr = (*rcsopen)(&RCSbuf, &RCSstat, mustread);
- RCSerrno = errno;
- } else {
- bufscpy(&RCSbuf, "");
- if (RCS1)
- /* RCS filename was given without path. */
- VOID fin2open(arg, (size_t)0, RCSbase, baselen,
- x, strlen(x), rcsopen, mustread
- );
- else {
- /* No RCS pathname was given. */
- /* Try each suffix in turn. */
- dlen = base-arg;
- x = suffixes;
- while (! fin2open(arg, dlen, base, baselen,
- x, xlen=suffixlen(x), rcsopen, mustread
- )) {
- x += xlen;
- if (!*x++)
- break;
- }
- }
- }
- RCSname = p = RCSbuf.string;
- if (finptr) {
- if (!S_ISREG(RCSstat.st_mode)) {
- error("%s isn't a regular file -- ignored", p);
- return 0;
- }
- Lexinit(); getadmin();
- } else {
- if (RCSerrno!=ENOENT || mustread || fdlock<0) {
- if (RCSerrno == EEXIST)
- error("RCS file %s is in use", p);
- else if (!quiet || RCSerrno!=ENOENT)
- enerror(RCSerrno, p);
- return 0;
- }
- InitAdmin();
- };
-
- if (paired && workstdout)
- workwarn("Working file ignored due to -p option");
-
- prevkeys = false;
- return finptr ? 1 : -1;
-}
-
-
- char const *
-getfullRCSname()
-/*
- * Return a pointer to the full pathname of the RCS file.
- * Remove leading `./'.
- */
-{
- if (ROOTPATH(RCSname)) {
- return RCSname;
- } else {
- static struct buf rcsbuf;
-# if needs_getabsname
- bufalloc(&rcsbuf, SIZEABLE_PATH + 1);
- while (getabsname(RCSname, rcsbuf.string, rcsbuf.size) != 0)
- if (errno == ERANGE)
- bufalloc(&rcsbuf, rcsbuf.size<<1);
- else
- efaterror("getabsname");
-# else
- static char const *wdptr;
- static struct buf wdbuf;
- static size_t wdlen;
-
- register char const *r;
- register size_t dlen;
- register char *d;
- register char const *wd;
-
- if (!(wd = wdptr)) {
- /* Get working directory for the first time. */
- char *PWD = cgetenv("PWD");
- struct stat PWDstat, dotstat;
- if (! (
- (d = PWD) &&
- ROOTPATH(PWD) &&
- stat(PWD, &PWDstat) == 0 &&
- stat(".", &dotstat) == 0 &&
- same_file(PWDstat, dotstat, 1)
- )) {
- bufalloc(&wdbuf, SIZEABLE_PATH + 1);
-# if has_getcwd || !has_getwd
- while (!(d = getcwd(wdbuf.string, wdbuf.size)))
- if (errno == ERANGE)
- bufalloc(&wdbuf, wdbuf.size<<1);
- else if ((d = PWD))
- break;
- else
- efaterror("getcwd");
-# else
- d = getwd(wdbuf.string);
- if (!d && !(d = PWD))
- efaterror("getwd");
-# endif
- }
- wdlen = dir_useful_len(d);
- d[wdlen] = 0;
- wdptr = wd = d;
- }
- /*
- * Remove leading `./'s from RCSname.
- * Do not try to handle `../', since removing it may yield
- * the wrong answer in the presence of symbolic links.
- */
- for (r = RCSname; r[0]=='.' && isSLASH(r[1]); r += 2)
- /* `.////' is equivalent to `./'. */
- while (isSLASH(r[2]))
- r++;
- /* Build full pathname. */
- dlen = wdlen;
- bufalloc(&rcsbuf, dlen + strlen(r) + 2);
- d = rcsbuf.string;
- VOID memcpy(d, wd, dlen);
- d += dlen;
- *d++ = SLASH;
- VOID strcpy(d, r);
-# endif
- return rcsbuf.string;
- }
-}
-
-/* Derived from code from the XFree86 project */
- char const *
-getfullCVSname()
-/* Function: returns a pointer to the path name of the RCS file with the
- * CVSROOT part stripped off, and with 'Attic/' stripped off (if present).
- */
-{
-
-#define ATTICDIR "/Attic"
-
- char const *namebuf = getfullRCSname();
- char *cvsroot = cgetenv("CVSROOT");
- int cvsrootlen;
- char *c = NULL;
- int alen = strlen(ATTICDIR);
-
- if ((c = strrchr(namebuf, '/')) != NULL) {
- if (namebuf - c >= alen) {
- if (!strncmp(c - alen, ATTICDIR, alen)) {
- while(*c != '\0') {
- *(c - alen) = *c;
- c++;
- }
- *(c - alen) = '\0';
- }
- }
- }
-
- if (!cvsroot)
- return(namebuf);
- else
- {
- cvsrootlen = strlen(cvsroot);
- if (!strncmp(namebuf, cvsroot, cvsrootlen) &&
- namebuf[cvsrootlen] == '/')
- return(namebuf + cvsrootlen + 1);
- else
- return(namebuf);
- }
-}
-
- static size_t
-dir_useful_len(d)
- char const *d;
-/*
-* D names a directory; yield the number of characters of D's useful part.
-* To create a file in D, append a SLASH and a file name to D's useful part.
-* Ignore trailing slashes if possible; not only are they ugly,
-* but some non-Posix systems misbehave unless the slashes are omitted.
-*/
-{
-# ifndef SLASHSLASH_is_SLASH
-# define SLASHSLASH_is_SLASH 0
-# endif
- size_t dlen = strlen(d);
- if (!SLASHSLASH_is_SLASH && dlen==2 && isSLASH(d[0]) && isSLASH(d[1]))
- --dlen;
- else
- while (dlen && isSLASH(d[dlen-1]))
- --dlen;
- return dlen;
-}
-
-#ifndef isSLASH
- int
-isSLASH(c)
- int c;
-{
- switch (c) {
- case SLASHes:
- return true;
- default:
- return false;
- }
-}
-#endif
-
-
-#if !has_getcwd && !has_getwd
-
- char *
-getcwd(path, size)
- char *path;
- size_t size;
-{
- static char const usrbinpwd[] = "/usr/bin/pwd";
-# define binpwd (usrbinpwd+4)
-
- register FILE *fp;
- register int c;
- register char *p, *lim;
- int closeerrno, closeerror, e, fd[2], readerror, toolong, wstatus;
- pid_t child;
-
- if (!size) {
- errno = EINVAL;
- return 0;
- }
- if (pipe(fd) != 0)
- return 0;
-# if bad_wait_if_SIGCHLD_ignored
-# ifndef SIGCHLD
-# define SIGCHLD SIGCLD
-# endif
- VOID signal(SIGCHLD, SIG_DFL);
-# endif
- if (!(child = vfork())) {
- if (
- close(fd[0]) == 0 &&
- (fd[1] == STDOUT_FILENO ||
-# ifdef F_DUPFD
- (VOID close(STDOUT_FILENO),
- fcntl(fd[1], F_DUPFD, STDOUT_FILENO))
-# else
- dup2(fd[1], STDOUT_FILENO)
-# endif
- == STDOUT_FILENO &&
- close(fd[1]) == 0
- )
- ) {
- VOID close(STDERR_FILENO);
- VOID execl(binpwd, binpwd, (char *)0);
- VOID execl(usrbinpwd, usrbinpwd, (char *)0);
- }
- _exit(EXIT_FAILURE);
- }
- e = errno;
- closeerror = close(fd[1]);
- closeerrno = errno;
- fp = 0;
- readerror = toolong = wstatus = 0;
- p = path;
- if (0 <= child) {
- fp = fdopen(fd[0], "r");
- e = errno;
- if (fp) {
- lim = p + size;
- for (p = path; ; *p++ = c) {
- if ((c=getc(fp)) < 0) {
- if (feof(fp))
- break;
- if (ferror(fp)) {
- readerror = 1;
- e = errno;
- break;
- }
- }
- if (p == lim) {
- toolong = 1;
- break;
- }
- }
- }
-# if has_waitpid
- if (waitpid(child, &wstatus, 0) < 0)
- wstatus = 1;
-# else
- {
- pid_t w;
- do {
- if ((w = wait(&wstatus)) < 0) {
- wstatus = 1;
- break;
- }
- } while (w != child);
- }
-# endif
- }
- if (!fp) {
- VOID close(fd[0]);
- errno = e;
- return 0;
- }
- if (fclose(fp) != 0)
- return 0;
- if (readerror) {
- errno = e;
- return 0;
- }
- if (closeerror) {
- errno = closeerrno;
- return 0;
- }
- if (toolong) {
- errno = ERANGE;
- return 0;
- }
- if (wstatus || p == path || *--p != '\n') {
- errno = EACCES;
- return 0;
- }
- *p = '\0';
- return path;
-}
-#endif
-
-
-#ifdef PAIRTEST
-/* test program for pairnames() and getfullRCSname() */
-
-char const cmdid[] = "pair";
-
-main(argc, argv)
-int argc; char *argv[];
-{
- int result;
- int initflag;
- quietflag = initflag = false;
-
- while(--argc, ++argv, argc>=1 && ((*argv)[0] == '-')) {
- switch ((*argv)[1]) {
-
- case 'p': workstdout = stdout;
- break;
- case 'i': initflag=true;
- break;
- case 'q': quietflag=true;
- break;
- default: error("unknown option: %s", *argv);
- break;
- }
- }
-
- do {
- RCSname = workname = 0;
- result = pairnames(argc,argv,rcsreadopen,!initflag,quietflag);
- if (result!=0) {
- diagnose("RCS pathname: %s; working pathname: %s\nFull RCS pathname: %s\n",
- RCSname, workname, getfullRCSname()
- );
- }
- switch (result) {
- case 0: continue; /* already paired file */
-
- case 1: if (initflag) {
- rcserror("already exists");
- } else {
- diagnose("RCS file %s exists\n", RCSname);
- }
- Ifclose(finptr);
- break;
-
- case -1:diagnose("RCS file doesn't exist\n");
- break;
- }
-
- } while (++argv, --argc>=1);
-
-}
-
- void
-exiterr()
-{
- dirtempunlink();
- tempunlink();
- _exit(EXIT_FAILURE);
-}
-#endif
diff --git a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsgen.c b/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsgen.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 35d8702..0000000
--- a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsgen.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,681 +0,0 @@
-/* Generate RCS revisions. */
-
-/* Copyright 1982, 1988, 1989 Walter Tichy
- Copyright 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995 Paul Eggert
- Distributed under license by the Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-
-This file is part of RCS.
-
-RCS is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
-it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
-any later version.
-
-RCS is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
-GNU General Public License for more details.
-
-You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-along with RCS; see the file COPYING.
-If not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
-59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
-
-Report problems and direct all questions to:
-
- rcs-bugs@cs.purdue.edu
-
-*/
-
-/*
- * Revision 5.16 1995/06/16 06:19:24 eggert
- * Update FSF address.
- *
- * Revision 5.15 1995/06/01 16:23:43 eggert
- * (putadmin): Open RCS file with FOPEN_WB.
- *
- * Revision 5.14 1994/03/17 14:05:48 eggert
- * Work around SVR4 stdio performance bug.
- * Flush stderr after prompt. Remove lint.
- *
- * Revision 5.13 1993/11/03 17:42:27 eggert
- * Don't discard ignored phrases. Improve quality of diagnostics.
- *
- * Revision 5.12 1992/07/28 16:12:44 eggert
- * Statement macro names now end in _.
- * Be consistent about pathnames vs filenames.
- *
- * Revision 5.11 1992/01/24 18:44:19 eggert
- * Move put routines here from rcssyn.c.
- * Add support for bad_creat0.
- *
- * Revision 5.10 1991/10/07 17:32:46 eggert
- * Fix log bugs, e.g. ci -t/dev/null when has_mmap.
- *
- * Revision 5.9 1991/09/10 22:15:46 eggert
- * Fix test for redirected stdin.
- *
- * Revision 5.8 1991/08/19 03:13:55 eggert
- * Add piece tables. Tune.
- *
- * Revision 5.7 1991/04/21 11:58:24 eggert
- * Add MS-DOS support.
- *
- * Revision 5.6 1990/12/27 19:54:26 eggert
- * Fix bug: rcs -t inserted \n, making RCS file grow.
- *
- * Revision 5.5 1990/12/04 05:18:45 eggert
- * Use -I for prompts and -q for diagnostics.
- *
- * Revision 5.4 1990/11/01 05:03:47 eggert
- * Add -I and new -t behavior. Permit arbitrary data in logs.
- *
- * Revision 5.3 1990/09/21 06:12:43 hammer
- * made putdesc() treat stdin the same whether or not it was from a terminal
- * by making it recognize that a single '.' was then end of the
- * description always
- *
- * Revision 5.2 1990/09/04 08:02:25 eggert
- * Fix `co -p1.1 -ko' bug. Standardize yes-or-no procedure.
- *
- * Revision 5.1 1990/08/29 07:14:01 eggert
- * Clean old log messages too.
- *
- * Revision 5.0 1990/08/22 08:12:52 eggert
- * Remove compile-time limits; use malloc instead.
- * Ansify and Posixate.
- *
- * Revision 4.7 89/05/01 15:12:49 narten
- * changed copyright header to reflect current distribution rules
- *
- * Revision 4.6 88/08/28 14:59:10 eggert
- * Shrink stdio code size; allow cc -R; remove lint; isatty() -> ttystdin()
- *
- * Revision 4.5 87/12/18 11:43:25 narten
- * additional lint cleanups, and a bug fix from the 4.3BSD version that
- * keeps "ci" from sticking a '\377' into the description if you run it
- * with a zero-length file as the description. (Guy Harris)
- *
- * Revision 4.4 87/10/18 10:35:10 narten
- * Updating version numbers. Changes relative to 1.1 actually relative to
- * 4.2
- *
- * Revision 1.3 87/09/24 13:59:51 narten
- * Sources now pass through lint (if you ignore printf/sprintf/fprintf
- * warnings)
- *
- * Revision 1.2 87/03/27 14:22:27 jenkins
- * Port to suns
- *
- * Revision 4.2 83/12/02 23:01:39 wft
- * merged 4.1 and 3.3.1.1 (clearerr(stdin)).
- *
- * Revision 4.1 83/05/10 16:03:33 wft
- * Changed putamin() to abort if trying to reread redirected stdin.
- * Fixed getdesc() to output a prompt on initial newline.
- *
- * Revision 3.3.1.1 83/10/19 04:21:51 lepreau
- * Added clearerr(stdin) for re-reading description from stdin.
- *
- * Revision 3.3 82/11/28 21:36:49 wft
- * 4.2 prerelease
- *
- * Revision 3.3 82/11/28 21:36:49 wft
- * Replaced ferror() followed by fclose() with ffclose().
- * Putdesc() now suppresses the prompts if stdin
- * is not a terminal. A pointer to the current log message is now
- * inserted into the corresponding delta, rather than leaving it in a
- * global variable.
- *
- * Revision 3.2 82/10/18 21:11:26 wft
- * I added checks for write errors during editing, and improved
- * the prompt on putdesc().
- *
- * Revision 3.1 82/10/13 15:55:09 wft
- * corrected type of variables assigned to by getc (char --> int)
- */
-
-
-
-
-#include "rcsbase.h"
-
-libId(genId, "$FreeBSD$")
-
-int interactiveflag; /* Should we act as if stdin is a tty? */
-struct buf curlogbuf; /* buffer for current log message */
-
-enum stringwork { enter, copy, edit, expand, edit_expand };
-
-static void putdelta P((struct hshentry const*,FILE*));
-static void scandeltatext P((struct hshentry*,enum stringwork,int));
-
-
-
-
- char const *
-buildrevision(deltas, target, outfile, expandflag)
- struct hshentries const *deltas;
- struct hshentry *target;
- FILE *outfile;
- int expandflag;
-/* Function: Generates the revision given by target
- * by retrieving all deltas given by parameter deltas and combining them.
- * If outfile is set, the revision is output to it,
- * otherwise written into a temporary file.
- * Temporary files are allocated by maketemp().
- * if expandflag is set, keyword expansion is performed.
- * Return 0 if outfile is set, the name of the temporary file otherwise.
- *
- * Algorithm: Copy initial revision unchanged. Then edit all revisions but
- * the last one into it, alternating input and output files (resultname and
- * editname). The last revision is then edited in, performing simultaneous
- * keyword substitution (this saves one extra pass).
- * All this simplifies if only one revision needs to be generated,
- * or no keyword expansion is necessary, or if output goes to stdout.
- */
-{
- if (deltas->first == target) {
- /* only latest revision to generate */
- openfcopy(outfile);
- scandeltatext(target, expandflag?expand:copy, true);
- if (outfile)
- return 0;
- else {
- Ozclose(&fcopy);
- return resultname;
- }
- } else {
- /* several revisions to generate */
- /* Get initial revision without keyword expansion. */
- scandeltatext(deltas->first, enter, false);
- while ((deltas=deltas->rest)->rest) {
- /* do all deltas except last one */
- scandeltatext(deltas->first, edit, false);
- }
- if (expandflag || outfile) {
- /* first, get to beginning of file*/
- finishedit((struct hshentry*)0, outfile, false);
- }
- scandeltatext(target, expandflag?edit_expand:edit, true);
- finishedit(
- expandflag ? target : (struct hshentry*)0,
- outfile, true
- );
- if (outfile)
- return 0;
- Ozclose(&fcopy);
- return resultname;
- }
-}
-
-
-
- static void
-scandeltatext(delta, func, needlog)
- struct hshentry *delta;
- enum stringwork func;
- int needlog;
-/* Function: Scans delta text nodes up to and including the one given
- * by delta. For the one given by delta, the log message is saved into
- * delta->log if needlog is set; func specifies how to handle the text.
- * Similarly, if needlog, delta->igtext is set to the ignored phrases.
- * Assumes the initial lexeme must be read in first.
- * Does not advance nexttok after it is finished.
- */
-{
- struct hshentry const *nextdelta;
- struct cbuf cb;
-
- for (;;) {
- if (eoflex())
- fatserror("can't find delta for revision %s", delta->num);
- nextlex();
- if (!(nextdelta=getnum())) {
- fatserror("delta number corrupted");
- }
- getkeystring(Klog);
- if (needlog && delta==nextdelta) {
- cb = savestring(&curlogbuf);
- delta->log = cleanlogmsg(curlogbuf.string, cb.size);
- nextlex();
- delta->igtext = getphrases(Ktext);
- } else {readstring();
- ignorephrases(Ktext);
- }
- getkeystring(Ktext);
-
- if (delta==nextdelta)
- break;
- readstring(); /* skip over it */
-
- }
- switch (func) {
- case enter: enterstring(); break;
- case copy: copystring(); break;
- case expand: xpandstring(delta); break;
- case edit: editstring((struct hshentry *)0); break;
- case edit_expand: editstring(delta); break;
- }
-}
-
- struct cbuf
-cleanlogmsg(m, s)
- char *m;
- size_t s;
-{
- register char *t = m;
- register char const *f = t;
- struct cbuf r;
- while (s) {
- --s;
- if ((*t++ = *f++) == '\n')
- while (m < --t)
- if (t[-1]!=' ' && t[-1]!='\t') {
- *t++ = '\n';
- break;
- }
- }
- while (m < t && (t[-1]==' ' || t[-1]=='\t' || t[-1]=='\n'))
- --t;
- r.string = m;
- r.size = t - m;
- return r;
-}
-
-
-int ttystdin()
-{
- static int initialized;
- if (!initialized) {
- if (!interactiveflag)
- interactiveflag = isatty(STDIN_FILENO);
- initialized = true;
- }
- return interactiveflag;
-}
-
- int
-getcstdin()
-{
- register FILE *in;
- register int c;
-
- in = stdin;
- if (feof(in) && ttystdin())
- clearerr(in);
- c = getc(in);
- if (c == EOF) {
- testIerror(in);
- if (feof(in) && ttystdin())
- afputc('\n',stderr);
- }
- return c;
-}
-
-#if has_prototypes
- int
-yesorno(int default_answer, char const *question, ...)
-#else
- /*VARARGS2*/ int
- yesorno(default_answer, question, va_alist)
- int default_answer; char const *question; va_dcl
-#endif
-{
- va_list args;
- register int c, r;
- if (!quietflag && ttystdin()) {
- oflush();
- vararg_start(args, question);
- fvfprintf(stderr, question, args);
- va_end(args);
- eflush();
- r = c = getcstdin();
- while (c!='\n' && !feof(stdin))
- c = getcstdin();
- if (r=='y' || r=='Y')
- return true;
- if (r=='n' || r=='N')
- return false;
- }
- return default_answer;
-}
-
-
- void
-putdesc(textflag, textfile)
- int textflag;
- char *textfile;
-/* Function: puts the descriptive text into file frewrite.
- * if finptr && !textflag, the text is copied from the old description.
- * Otherwise, if textfile, the text is read from that
- * file, or from stdin, if !textfile.
- * A textfile with a leading '-' is treated as a string, not a pathname.
- * If finptr, the old descriptive text is discarded.
- * Always clears foutptr.
- */
-{
- static struct buf desc;
- static struct cbuf desclean;
-
- register FILE *txt;
- register int c;
- register FILE * frew;
- register char *p;
- register size_t s;
- char const *plim;
-
- frew = frewrite;
- if (finptr && !textflag) {
- /* copy old description */
- aprintf(frew, "\n\n%s%c", Kdesc, nextc);
- foutptr = frewrite;
- getdesc(false);
- foutptr = 0;
- } else {
- foutptr = 0;
- /* get new description */
- if (finptr) {
- /*skip old description*/
- getdesc(false);
- }
- aprintf(frew,"\n\n%s\n%c",Kdesc,SDELIM);
- if (!textfile)
- desclean = getsstdin(
- "t-", "description",
- "NOTE: This is NOT the log message!\n", &desc
- );
- else if (!desclean.string) {
- if (*textfile == '-') {
- p = textfile + 1;
- s = strlen(p);
- } else {
- if (!(txt = fopenSafer(textfile, "r")))
- efaterror(textfile);
- bufalloc(&desc, 1);
- p = desc.string;
- plim = p + desc.size;
- for (;;) {
- if ((c=getc(txt)) == EOF) {
- testIerror(txt);
- if (feof(txt))
- break;
- }
- if (plim <= p)
- p = bufenlarge(&desc, &plim);
- *p++ = c;
- }
- if (fclose(txt) != 0)
- Ierror();
- s = p - desc.string;
- p = desc.string;
- }
- desclean = cleanlogmsg(p, s);
- }
- putstring(frew, false, desclean, true);
- aputc_('\n', frew)
- }
-}
-
- struct cbuf
-getsstdin(option, name, note, buf)
- char const *option, *name, *note;
- struct buf *buf;
-{
- register int c;
- register char *p;
- register size_t i;
- register int tty = ttystdin();
-
- if (tty) {
- aprintf(stderr,
- "enter %s, terminated with single '.' or end of file:\n%s>> ",
- name, note
- );
- eflush();
- } else if (feof(stdin))
- rcsfaterror("can't reread redirected stdin for %s; use -%s<%s>",
- name, option, name
- );
-
- for (
- i = 0, p = 0;
- c = getcstdin(), !feof(stdin);
- bufrealloc(buf, i+1), p = buf->string, p[i++] = c
- )
- if (c == '\n')
- if (i && p[i-1]=='.' && (i==1 || p[i-2]=='\n')) {
- /* Remove trailing '.'. */
- --i;
- break;
- } else if (tty) {
- aputs(">> ", stderr);
- eflush();
- }
- return cleanlogmsg(p, i);
-}
-
-
- void
-putadmin()
-/* Output the admin node. */
-{
- register FILE *fout;
- struct assoc const *curassoc;
- struct rcslock const *curlock;
- struct access const *curaccess;
-
- if (!(fout = frewrite)) {
-# if bad_creat0
- ORCSclose();
- fout = fopenSafer(makedirtemp(0), FOPEN_WB);
-# else
- int fo = fdlock;
- fdlock = -1;
- fout = fdopen(fo, FOPEN_WB);
-# endif
-
- if (!(frewrite = fout))
- efaterror(RCSname);
- }
-
- /*
- * Output the first character with putc, not printf.
- * Otherwise, an SVR4 stdio bug buffers output inefficiently.
- */
- aputc_(*Khead, fout)
- aprintf(fout, "%s\t%s;\n", Khead + 1, Head?Head->num:"");
- if (Dbranch && VERSION(4)<=RCSversion)
- aprintf(fout, "%s\t%s;\n", Kbranch, Dbranch);
-
- aputs(Kaccess, fout);
- curaccess = AccessList;
- while (curaccess) {
- aprintf(fout, "\n\t%s", curaccess->login);
- curaccess = curaccess->nextaccess;
- }
- aprintf(fout, ";\n%s", Ksymbols);
- curassoc = Symbols;
- while (curassoc) {
- aprintf(fout, "\n\t%s:%s", curassoc->symbol, curassoc->num);
- curassoc = curassoc->nextassoc;
- }
- aprintf(fout, ";\n%s", Klocks);
- curlock = Locks;
- while (curlock) {
- aprintf(fout, "\n\t%s:%s", curlock->login, curlock->delta->num);
- curlock = curlock->nextlock;
- }
- if (StrictLocks) aprintf(fout, "; %s", Kstrict);
- aprintf(fout, ";\n");
- if (Comment.size) {
- aprintf(fout, "%s\t", Kcomment);
- putstring(fout, true, Comment, false);
- aprintf(fout, ";\n");
- }
- if (Expand != KEYVAL_EXPAND)
- aprintf(fout, "%s\t%c%s%c;\n",
- Kexpand, SDELIM, expand_names[Expand], SDELIM
- );
- awrite(Ignored.string, Ignored.size, fout);
- aputc_('\n', fout)
-}
-
-
- static void
-putdelta(node, fout)
- register struct hshentry const *node;
- register FILE * fout;
-/* Output the delta NODE to FOUT. */
-{
- struct branchhead const *nextbranch;
-
- if (!node) return;
-
- aprintf(fout, "\n%s\n%s\t%s;\t%s %s;\t%s %s;\nbranches",
- node->num,
- Kdate, node->date,
- Kauthor, node->author,
- Kstate, node->state?node->state:""
- );
- nextbranch = node->branches;
- while (nextbranch) {
- aprintf(fout, "\n\t%s", nextbranch->hsh->num);
- nextbranch = nextbranch->nextbranch;
- }
-
- aprintf(fout, ";\n%s\t%s;\n", Knext, node->next?node->next->num:"");
- awrite(node->ig.string, node->ig.size, fout);
-}
-
-
- void
-puttree(root, fout)
- struct hshentry const *root;
- register FILE *fout;
-/* Output the delta tree with base ROOT in preorder to FOUT. */
-{
- struct branchhead const *nextbranch;
-
- if (!root) return;
-
- if (root->selector)
- putdelta(root, fout);
-
- puttree(root->next, fout);
-
- nextbranch = root->branches;
- while (nextbranch) {
- puttree(nextbranch->hsh, fout);
- nextbranch = nextbranch->nextbranch;
- }
-}
-
-
- int
-putdtext(delta, srcname, fout, diffmt)
- struct hshentry const *delta;
- char const *srcname;
- FILE *fout;
- int diffmt;
-/*
- * Output a deltatext node with delta number DELTA->num, log message DELTA->log,
- * ignored phrases DELTA->igtext and text SRCNAME to FOUT.
- * Double up all SDELIMs in both the log and the text.
- * Make sure the log message ends in \n.
- * Return false on error.
- * If DIFFMT, also check that the text is valid diff -n output.
- */
-{
- RILE *fin;
- if (!(fin = Iopen(srcname, "r", (struct stat*)0))) {
- eerror(srcname);
- return false;
- }
- putdftext(delta, fin, fout, diffmt);
- Ifclose(fin);
- return true;
-}
-
- void
-putstring(out, delim, s, log)
- register FILE *out;
- struct cbuf s;
- int delim, log;
-/*
- * Output to OUT one SDELIM if DELIM, then the string S with SDELIMs doubled.
- * If LOG is set then S is a log string; append a newline if S is nonempty.
- */
-{
- register char const *sp;
- register size_t ss;
-
- if (delim)
- aputc_(SDELIM, out)
- sp = s.string;
- for (ss = s.size; ss; --ss) {
- if (*sp == SDELIM)
- aputc_(SDELIM, out)
- aputc_(*sp++, out)
- }
- if (s.size && log)
- aputc_('\n', out)
- aputc_(SDELIM, out)
-}
-
- void
-putdftext(delta, finfile, foutfile, diffmt)
- struct hshentry const *delta;
- RILE *finfile;
- FILE *foutfile;
- int diffmt;
-/* like putdtext(), except the source file is already open */
-{
- declarecache;
- register FILE *fout;
- register int c;
- register RILE *fin;
- int ed;
- struct diffcmd dc;
-
- fout = foutfile;
- aprintf(fout, DELNUMFORM, delta->num, Klog);
-
- /* put log */
- putstring(fout, true, delta->log, true);
- aputc_('\n', fout)
-
- /* put ignored phrases */
- awrite(delta->igtext.string, delta->igtext.size, fout);
-
- /* put text */
- aprintf(fout, "%s\n%c", Ktext, SDELIM);
-
- fin = finfile;
- setupcache(fin);
- if (!diffmt) {
- /* Copy the file */
- cache(fin);
- for (;;) {
- cachegeteof_(c, break;)
- if (c==SDELIM) aputc_(SDELIM, fout) /*double up SDELIM*/
- aputc_(c, fout)
- }
- } else {
- initdiffcmd(&dc);
- while (0 <= (ed = getdiffcmd(fin, false, fout, &dc)))
- if (ed) {
- cache(fin);
- while (dc.nlines--)
- do {
- cachegeteof_(c, { if (!dc.nlines) goto OK_EOF; unexpected_EOF(); })
- if (c == SDELIM)
- aputc_(SDELIM, fout)
- aputc_(c, fout)
- } while (c != '\n');
- uncache(fin);
- }
- }
- OK_EOF:
- aprintf(fout, "%c\n", SDELIM);
-}
diff --git a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcskeep.c b/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcskeep.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 4a90f85..0000000
--- a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcskeep.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,452 +0,0 @@
-/* Extract RCS keyword string values from working files. */
-
-/* Copyright 1982, 1988, 1989 Walter Tichy
- Copyright 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995 Paul Eggert
- Distributed under license by the Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-
-This file is part of RCS.
-
-RCS is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
-it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
-any later version.
-
-RCS is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
-GNU General Public License for more details.
-
-You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-along with RCS; see the file COPYING.
-If not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
-59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
-
-Report problems and direct all questions to:
-
- rcs-bugs@cs.purdue.edu
-
-*/
-
-/*
- * Revision 5.10 1995/06/16 06:19:24 eggert
- * Update FSF address.
- *
- * Revision 5.9 1995/06/01 16:23:43 eggert
- * (getoldkeys): Don't panic if a Name: is empty.
- *
- * Revision 5.8 1994/03/17 14:05:48 eggert
- * Remove lint.
- *
- * Revision 5.7 1993/11/09 17:40:15 eggert
- * Use simpler timezone parsing strategy now that we're using ISO 8601 format.
- *
- * Revision 5.6 1993/11/03 17:42:27 eggert
- * Scan for Name keyword. Improve quality of diagnostics.
- *
- * Revision 5.5 1992/07/28 16:12:44 eggert
- * Statement macro names now end in _.
- *
- * Revision 5.4 1991/08/19 03:13:55 eggert
- * Tune.
- *
- * Revision 5.3 1991/04/21 11:58:25 eggert
- * Shorten names to keep them distinct on shortname hosts.
- *
- * Revision 5.2 1990/10/04 06:30:20 eggert
- * Parse time zone offsets; future RCS versions may output them.
- *
- * Revision 5.1 1990/09/20 02:38:56 eggert
- * ci -k now checks dates more thoroughly.
- *
- * Revision 5.0 1990/08/22 08:12:53 eggert
- * Retrieve old log message if there is one.
- * Don't require final newline.
- * Remove compile-time limits; use malloc instead. Tune.
- * Permit dates past 1999/12/31. Ansify and Posixate.
- *
- * Revision 4.6 89/05/01 15:12:56 narten
- * changed copyright header to reflect current distribution rules
- *
- * Revision 4.5 88/08/09 19:13:03 eggert
- * Remove lint and speed up by making FILE *fp local, not global.
- *
- * Revision 4.4 87/12/18 11:44:21 narten
- * more lint cleanups (Guy Harris)
- *
- * Revision 4.3 87/10/18 10:35:50 narten
- * Updating version numbers. Changes relative to 1.1 actually relative
- * to 4.1
- *
- * Revision 1.3 87/09/24 14:00:00 narten
- * Sources now pass through lint (if you ignore printf/sprintf/fprintf
- * warnings)
- *
- * Revision 1.2 87/03/27 14:22:29 jenkins
- * Port to suns
- *
- * Revision 4.1 83/05/10 16:26:44 wft
- * Added new markers Id and RCSfile; extraction added.
- * Marker matching with trymatch().
- *
- * Revision 3.2 82/12/24 12:08:26 wft
- * added missing #endif.
- *
- * Revision 3.1 82/12/04 13:22:41 wft
- * Initial revision.
- *
- */
-
-#include "rcsbase.h"
-
-libId(keepId, "$FreeBSD$")
-
-static int badly_terminated P((void));
-static int checknum P((char const*));
-static int get0val P((int,RILE*,struct buf*,int));
-static int getval P((RILE*,struct buf*,int));
-static int keepdate P((RILE*));
-static int keepid P((int,RILE*,struct buf*));
-static int keeprev P((RILE*));
-
-int prevkeys;
-struct buf prevauthor, prevdate, prevname, prevrev, prevstate;
-
- int
-getoldkeys(fp)
- register RILE *fp;
-/* Function: Tries to read keyword values for author, date,
- * revision number, and state out of the file fp.
- * If fp is null, workname is opened and closed instead of using fp.
- * The results are placed into
- * prevauthor, prevdate, prevname, prevrev, prevstate.
- * Aborts immediately if it finds an error and returns false.
- * If it returns true, it doesn't mean that any of the
- * values were found; instead, check to see whether the corresponding arrays
- * contain the empty string.
- */
-{
- register int c;
- char keyword[keylength+1];
- register char * tp;
- int needs_closing;
- int prevname_found;
-
- if (prevkeys)
- return true;
-
- needs_closing = false;
- if (!fp) {
- if (!(fp = Iopen(workname, FOPEN_R_WORK, (struct stat*)0))) {
- eerror(workname);
- return false;
- }
- needs_closing = true;
- }
-
- /* initialize to empty */
- bufscpy(&prevauthor, "");
- bufscpy(&prevdate, "");
- bufscpy(&prevname, ""); prevname_found = 0;
- bufscpy(&prevrev, "");
- bufscpy(&prevstate, "");
-
- c = '\0'; /* anything but KDELIM */
- for (;;) {
- if ( c==KDELIM) {
- do {
- /* try to get keyword */
- tp = keyword;
- for (;;) {
- Igeteof_(fp, c, goto ok;)
- switch (c) {
- default:
- if (keyword+keylength <= tp)
- break;
- *tp++ = c;
- continue;
-
- case '\n': case KDELIM: case VDELIM:
- break;
- }
- break;
- }
- } while (c==KDELIM);
- if (c!=VDELIM) continue;
- *tp = c;
- Igeteof_(fp, c, break;)
- switch (c) {
- case ' ': case '\t': break;
- default: continue;
- }
-
- switch (trymatch(keyword)) {
- case Author:
- if (!keepid(0, fp, &prevauthor))
- return false;
- c = 0;
- break;
- case Date:
- if (!(c = keepdate(fp)))
- return false;
- break;
- case Header:
- case Id:
- case LocalId:
- if (!(
- getval(fp, (struct buf*)0, false) &&
- keeprev(fp) &&
- (c = keepdate(fp)) &&
- keepid(c, fp, &prevauthor) &&
- keepid(0, fp, &prevstate)
- ))
- return false;
- /* Skip either ``who'' (new form) or ``Locker: who'' (old). */
- if (getval(fp, (struct buf*)0, true) &&
- getval(fp, (struct buf*)0, true))
- c = 0;
- else if (nerror)
- return false;
- else
- c = KDELIM;
- break;
- case Locker:
- (void) getval(fp, (struct buf*)0, false);
- c = 0;
- break;
- case Log:
- case RCSfile:
- case Source:
- if (!getval(fp, (struct buf*)0, false))
- return false;
- c = 0;
- break;
- case Name:
- if (getval(fp, &prevname, false)) {
- if (*prevname.string)
- checkssym(prevname.string);
- prevname_found = 1;
- }
- c = 0;
- break;
- case Revision:
- if (!keeprev(fp))
- return false;
- c = 0;
- break;
- case State:
- if (!keepid(0, fp, &prevstate))
- return false;
- c = 0;
- break;
- default:
- continue;
- }
- if (!c)
- Igeteof_(fp, c, c=0;)
- if (c != KDELIM) {
- workerror("closing %c missing on keyword", KDELIM);
- return false;
- }
- if (prevname_found &&
- *prevauthor.string && *prevdate.string &&
- *prevrev.string && *prevstate.string
- )
- break;
- }
- Igeteof_(fp, c, break;)
- }
-
- ok:
- if (needs_closing)
- Ifclose(fp);
- else
- Irewind(fp);
- prevkeys = true;
- return true;
-}
-
- static int
-badly_terminated()
-{
- workerror("badly terminated keyword value");
- return false;
-}
-
- static int
-getval(fp, target, optional)
- register RILE *fp;
- struct buf *target;
- int optional;
-/* Reads a keyword value from FP into TARGET.
- * Returns true if one is found, false otherwise.
- * Does not modify target if it is 0.
- * Do not report an error if OPTIONAL is set and KDELIM is found instead.
- */
-{
- int c;
- Igeteof_(fp, c, return badly_terminated();)
- return get0val(c, fp, target, optional);
-}
-
- static int
-get0val(c, fp, target, optional)
- register int c;
- register RILE *fp;
- struct buf *target;
- int optional;
-/* Reads a keyword value from C+FP into TARGET, perhaps OPTIONALly.
- * Same as getval, except C is the lookahead character.
- */
-{ register char * tp;
- char const *tlim;
- register int got1;
-
- if (target) {
- bufalloc(target, 1);
- tp = target->string;
- tlim = tp + target->size;
- } else
- tlim = tp = 0;
- got1 = false;
- for (;;) {
- switch (c) {
- default:
- got1 = true;
- if (tp) {
- *tp++ = c;
- if (tlim <= tp)
- tp = bufenlarge(target, &tlim);
- }
- break;
-
- case ' ':
- case '\t':
- if (tp) {
- *tp = 0;
-# ifdef KEEPTEST
- VOID printf("getval: %s\n", target);
-# endif
- }
- return got1;
-
- case KDELIM:
- if (!got1 && optional)
- return false;
- /* fall into */
- case '\n':
- case 0:
- return badly_terminated();
- }
- Igeteof_(fp, c, return badly_terminated();)
- }
-}
-
-
- static int
-keepdate(fp)
- RILE *fp;
-/* Function: reads a date prevdate; checks format
- * Return 0 on error, lookahead character otherwise.
- */
-{
- struct buf prevday, prevtime;
- register int c;
-
- c = 0;
- bufautobegin(&prevday);
- if (getval(fp,&prevday,false)) {
- bufautobegin(&prevtime);
- if (getval(fp,&prevtime,false)) {
- Igeteof_(fp, c, c=0;)
- if (c) {
- register char const *d = prevday.string, *t = prevtime.string;
- bufalloc(&prevdate, strlen(d) + strlen(t) + 9);
- VOID sprintf(prevdate.string, "%s%s %s%s",
- /* Parse dates put out by old versions of RCS. */
- isdigit(d[0]) && isdigit(d[1]) && !isdigit(d[2])
- ? "19" : "",
- d, t,
- strchr(t,'-') || strchr(t,'+') ? "" : "+0000"
- );
- }
- }
- bufautoend(&prevtime);
- }
- bufautoend(&prevday);
- return c;
-}
-
- static int
-keepid(c, fp, b)
- int c;
- RILE *fp;
- struct buf *b;
-/* Get previous identifier from C+FP into B. */
-{
- if (!c)
- Igeteof_(fp, c, return false;)
- if (!get0val(c, fp, b, false))
- return false;
- checksid(b->string);
- return !nerror;
-}
-
- static int
-keeprev(fp)
- RILE *fp;
-/* Get previous revision from FP into prevrev. */
-{
- return getval(fp,&prevrev,false) && checknum(prevrev.string);
-}
-
-
- static int
-checknum(s)
- char const *s;
-{
- register char const *sp;
- register int dotcount = 0;
- for (sp=s; ; sp++) {
- switch (*sp) {
- case 0:
- if (dotcount & 1)
- return true;
- else
- break;
-
- case '.':
- dotcount++;
- continue;
-
- default:
- if (isdigit(*sp))
- continue;
- break;
- }
- break;
- }
- workerror("%s is not a revision number", s);
- return false;
-}
-
-
-
-#ifdef KEEPTEST
-
-/* Print the keyword values found. */
-
-char const cmdid[] ="keeptest";
-
- int
-main(argc, argv)
-int argc; char *argv[];
-{
- while (*(++argv)) {
- workname = *argv;
- getoldkeys((RILE*)0);
- VOID printf("%s: revision: %s, date: %s, author: %s, name: %s, state: %s\n",
- *argv, prevrev.string, prevdate.string, prevauthor.string, prevname.string, prevstate.string);
- }
- exitmain(EXIT_SUCCESS);
-}
-#endif
diff --git a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcskeys.c b/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcskeys.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 378f57d..0000000
--- a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcskeys.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,186 +0,0 @@
-/* RCS keyword table and match operation */
-
-/* Copyright 1982, 1988, 1989 Walter Tichy
- Copyright 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1995 Paul Eggert
- Distributed under license by the Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-
-This file is part of RCS.
-
-RCS is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
-it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
-any later version.
-
-RCS is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
-GNU General Public License for more details.
-
-You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-along with RCS; see the file COPYING.
-If not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
-59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
-
-Report problems and direct all questions to:
-
- rcs-bugs@cs.purdue.edu
-
-*/
-
-/*
- * Revision 5.4 1995/06/16 06:19:24 eggert
- * Update FSF address.
- *
- * Revision 5.3 1993/11/03 17:42:27 eggert
- * Add Name keyword.
- *
- * Revision 5.2 1991/08/19 03:13:55 eggert
- * Say `T const' instead of `const T'; it's less confusing for pointer types.
- * (This change was made in other source files too.)
- *
- * Revision 5.1 1991/04/21 11:58:25 eggert
- * Don't put , just before } in initializer.
- *
- * Revision 5.0 1990/08/22 08:12:54 eggert
- * Add -k. Ansify and Posixate.
- *
- * Revision 4.3 89/05/01 15:13:02 narten
- * changed copyright header to reflect current distribution rules
- *
- * Revision 4.2 87/10/18 10:36:33 narten
- * Updating version numbers. Changes relative to 1.1 actuallyt
- * relative to 4.1
- *
- * Revision 1.2 87/09/24 14:00:10 narten
- * Sources now pass through lint (if you ignore printf/sprintf/fprintf
- * warnings)
- *
- * Revision 4.1 83/05/04 10:06:53 wft
- * Initial revision.
- *
- */
-
-
-#include "rcsbase.h"
-
-libId(keysId, "$FreeBSD$")
-
-
-char const *Keyword[] = {
- /* This must be in the same order as rcsbase.h's enum markers type. */
- 0,
- AUTHOR, DATE, HEADER, IDH,
- LOCKER, LOG, NAME, RCSFILE, REVISION, SOURCE, STATE, CVSHEADER,
- NULL
-};
-
-/* Expand all keywords by default */
-static int ExpandKeyword[] = {
- false,
- true, true, true, true,
- true, true, true, true, true, true, true, true,
- true
-};
-enum markers LocalIdMode = Id;
-
- enum markers
-trymatch(string)
- char const *string;
-/* function: Checks whether string starts with a keyword followed
- * by a KDELIM or a VDELIM.
- * If successful, returns the appropriate marker, otherwise Nomatch.
- */
-{
- register int j;
- register char const *p, *s;
- for (j = sizeof(Keyword)/sizeof(*Keyword); (--j); ) {
- if (!ExpandKeyword[j])
- continue;
- /* try next keyword */
- p = Keyword[j];
- if (p == NULL)
- continue;
- s = string;
- while (*p++ == *s++) {
- if (!*p)
- switch (*s) {
- case KDELIM:
- case VDELIM:
- return (enum markers)j;
- default:
- return Nomatch;
- }
- }
- }
- return(Nomatch);
-}
-
- void
-setIncExc(arg)
- char const *arg;
-/* Sets up the ExpandKeyword table according to command-line flags */
-{
- char *key;
- char *copy, *next;
- int include = 0, j;
-
- copy = strdup(arg);
- next = copy;
- switch (*next++) {
- case 'e':
- include = false;
- break;
- case 'i':
- include = true;
- break;
- default:
- free(copy);
- return;
- }
- if (include)
- for (j = sizeof(Keyword)/sizeof(*Keyword); (--j); )
- ExpandKeyword[j] = false;
- key = strtok(next, ",");
- while (key) {
- for (j = sizeof(Keyword)/sizeof(*Keyword); (--j); ) {
- if (Keyword[j] == NULL)
- continue;
- if (!strcmp(key, Keyword[j]))
- ExpandKeyword[j] = include;
- }
- key = strtok(NULL, ",");
- }
- free(copy);
- return;
-}
-
- void
-setRCSLocalId(string)
- char const *string;
-/* function: sets local RCS id and RCSLOCALID envariable */
-{
- static char local_id[keylength+1];
- char *copy, *next, *key;
- int j;
-
- copy = strdup(string);
- next = copy;
- key = strtok(next, "=");
- if (strlen(key) > keylength)
- faterror("LocalId is too long");
- VOID strcpy(local_id, key);
- Keyword[LocalId] = local_id;
-
- /* options? */
- while (key = strtok(NULL, ",")) {
- if (!strcmp(key, Keyword[Id]))
- LocalIdMode=Id;
- else if (!strcmp(key, Keyword[Header]))
- LocalIdMode=Header;
- else if (!strcmp(key, Keyword[CVSHeader]))
- LocalIdMode=CVSHeader;
- else
- error("Unknown LocalId mode");
- }
- free(copy);
-}
diff --git a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcslex.c b/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcslex.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 7a11f79..0000000
--- a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcslex.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,1568 +0,0 @@
-/* lexical analysis of RCS files */
-
-/******************************************************************************
- * Lexical Analysis.
- * hashtable, Lexinit, nextlex, getlex, getkey,
- * getid, getnum, readstring, printstring, savestring,
- * checkid, fatserror, error, faterror, warn, diagnose
- * Testprogram: define LEXDB
- ******************************************************************************
- */
-
-/* Copyright 1982, 1988, 1989 Walter Tichy
- Copyright 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995 Paul Eggert
- Distributed under license by the Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-
-This file is part of RCS.
-
-RCS is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
-it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
-any later version.
-
-RCS is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
-GNU General Public License for more details.
-
-You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-along with RCS; see the file COPYING.
-If not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
-59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
-
-Report problems and direct all questions to:
-
- rcs-bugs@cs.purdue.edu
-
-*/
-
-
-
-/*
- * Revision 5.19 1995/06/16 06:19:24 eggert
- * Update FSF address.
- *
- * Revision 5.18 1995/06/01 16:23:43 eggert
- * (map_fd_deallocate,mmap_deallocate,read_deallocate,nothing_to_deallocate):
- * New functions.
- * (Iclose): If large_memory and maps_memory, use them to deallocate mapping.
- * (fd2RILE): Use map_fd if available.
- * If one mapping method fails, try the next instead of giving up;
- * if they all fail, fall back on ordinary read.
- * Work around bug: root mmap over NFS succeeds, but accessing dumps core.
- * Use MAP_FAILED macro for mmap failure, and `char *' instead of caddr_t.
- * (advise_access): Use madvise only if this instance used mmap.
- * (Iopen): Use fdSafer to get safer file descriptor.
- * (aflush): Moved here from rcsedit.c.
- *
- * Revision 5.17 1994/03/20 04:52:58 eggert
- * Don't worry if madvise fails. Add Orewind. Remove lint.
- *
- * Revision 5.16 1993/11/09 17:55:29 eggert
- * Fix `label: }' typo.
- *
- * Revision 5.15 1993/11/03 17:42:27 eggert
- * Improve quality of diagnostics by putting file names in them more often.
- * Don't discard ignored phrases.
- *
- * Revision 5.14 1992/07/28 16:12:44 eggert
- * Identifiers may now start with a digit and (unless they are symbolic names)
- * may contain `.'. Avoid `unsigned'. Statement macro names now end in _.
- *
- * Revision 5.13 1992/02/17 23:02:27 eggert
- * Work around NFS mmap SIGBUS problem.
- *
- * Revision 5.12 1992/01/06 02:42:34 eggert
- * Use OPEN_O_BINARY if mode contains 'b'.
- *
- * Revision 5.11 1991/11/03 03:30:44 eggert
- * Fix porting bug to ancient hosts lacking vfprintf.
- *
- * Revision 5.10 1991/10/07 17:32:46 eggert
- * Support piece tables even if !has_mmap.
- *
- * Revision 5.9 1991/09/24 00:28:42 eggert
- * Don't export errsay().
- *
- * Revision 5.8 1991/08/19 03:13:55 eggert
- * Add eoflex(), mmap support. Tune.
- *
- * Revision 5.7 1991/04/21 11:58:26 eggert
- * Add MS-DOS support.
- *
- * Revision 5.6 1991/02/25 07:12:42 eggert
- * Work around fputs bug. strsave -> str_save (DG/UX name clash)
- *
- * Revision 5.5 1990/12/04 05:18:47 eggert
- * Use -I for prompts and -q for diagnostics.
- *
- * Revision 5.4 1990/11/19 20:05:28 hammer
- * no longer gives warning about unknown keywords if -q is specified
- *
- * Revision 5.3 1990/11/01 05:03:48 eggert
- * When ignoring unknown phrases, copy them to the output RCS file.
- *
- * Revision 5.2 1990/09/04 08:02:27 eggert
- * Count RCS lines better.
- *
- * Revision 5.1 1990/08/29 07:14:03 eggert
- * Work around buggy compilers with defective argument promotion.
- *
- * Revision 5.0 1990/08/22 08:12:55 eggert
- * Remove compile-time limits; use malloc instead.
- * Report errno-related errors with perror().
- * Ansify and Posixate. Add support for ISO 8859.
- * Use better hash function.
- *
- * Revision 4.6 89/05/01 15:13:07 narten
- * changed copyright header to reflect current distribution rules
- *
- * Revision 4.5 88/08/28 15:01:12 eggert
- * Don't loop when writing error messages to a full filesystem.
- * Flush stderr/stdout when mixing output.
- * Yield exit status compatible with diff(1).
- * Shrink stdio code size; allow cc -R; remove lint.
- *
- * Revision 4.4 87/12/18 11:44:47 narten
- * fixed to use "varargs" in "fprintf"; this is required if it is to
- * work on a SPARC machine such as a Sun-4
- *
- * Revision 4.3 87/10/18 10:37:18 narten
- * Updating version numbers. Changes relative to 1.1 actually relative
- * to version 4.1
- *
- * Revision 1.3 87/09/24 14:00:17 narten
- * Sources now pass through lint (if you ignore printf/sprintf/fprintf
- * warnings)
- *
- * Revision 1.2 87/03/27 14:22:33 jenkins
- * Port to suns
- *
- * Revision 4.1 83/03/25 18:12:51 wft
- * Only changed $Header to $Id.
- *
- * Revision 3.3 82/12/10 16:22:37 wft
- * Improved error messages, changed exit status on error to 1.
- *
- * Revision 3.2 82/11/28 21:27:10 wft
- * Renamed ctab to map and included EOFILE; ctab is now a macro in rcsbase.h.
- * Added fflsbuf(), fputs(), and fprintf(), which abort the RCS operations
- * properly in case there is an IO-error (e.g., file system full).
- *
- * Revision 3.1 82/10/11 19:43:56 wft
- * removed unused label out:;
- * made sure all calls to getc() return into an integer, not a char.
- */
-
-
-/*
-#define LEXDB
-*/
-/* version LEXDB is for testing the lexical analyzer. The testprogram
- * reads a stream of lexemes, enters the revision numbers into the
- * hashtable, and prints the recognized tokens. Keywords are recognized
- * as identifiers.
- */
-
-
-
-#include "rcsbase.h"
-
-libId(lexId, "$FreeBSD$")
-
-static char *checkidentifier P((char*,int,int));
-static void errsay P((char const*));
-static void fatsay P((char const*));
-static void lookup P((char const*));
-static void startsay P((const char*,const char*));
-static void warnsay P((char const*));
-
-static struct hshentry *nexthsh; /*pointer to next hash entry, set by lookup*/
-
-enum tokens nexttok; /*next token, set by nextlex */
-
-int hshenter; /*if true, next suitable lexeme will be entered */
- /*into the symbol table. Handle with care. */
-int nextc; /*next input character, initialized by Lexinit */
-
-long rcsline; /*current line-number of input */
-int nerror; /*counter for errors */
-int quietflag; /*indicates quiet mode */
-RILE * finptr; /*input file descriptor */
-
-FILE * frewrite; /*file descriptor for echoing input */
-
-FILE * foutptr; /* copy of frewrite, but 0 to suppress echo */
-
-static struct buf tokbuf; /* token buffer */
-
-char const * NextString; /* next token */
-
-/*
- * Our hash algorithm is h[0] = 0, h[i+1] = 4*h[i] + c,
- * so hshsize should be odd.
- * See B J McKenzie, R Harries & T Bell, Selecting a hashing algorithm,
- * Software--practice & experience 20, 2 (Feb 1990), 209-224.
- */
-#ifndef hshsize
-# define hshsize 511
-#endif
-
-static struct hshentry *hshtab[hshsize]; /*hashtable */
-
-static int ignored_phrases; /* have we ignored phrases in this RCS file? */
-
- void
-warnignore()
-{
- if (!ignored_phrases) {
- ignored_phrases = true;
- rcswarn("Unknown phrases like `%s ...;' are present.", NextString);
- }
-}
-
-
-
- static void
-lookup(str)
- char const *str;
-/* Function: Looks up the character string pointed to by str in the
- * hashtable. If the string is not present, a new entry for it is created.
- * In any case, the address of the corresponding hashtable entry is placed
- * into nexthsh.
- */
-{
- register unsigned ihash; /* index into hashtable */
- register char const *sp;
- register struct hshentry *n, **p;
-
- /* calculate hash code */
- sp = str;
- ihash = 0;
- while (*sp)
- ihash = (ihash<<2) + *sp++;
- ihash %= hshsize;
-
- for (p = &hshtab[ihash]; ; p = &n->nexthsh)
- if (!(n = *p)) {
- /* empty slot found */
- *p = n = ftalloc(struct hshentry);
- n->num = fstr_save(str);
- n->nexthsh = 0;
-# ifdef LEXDB
- VOID printf("\nEntered: %s at %u ", str, ihash);
-# endif
- break;
- } else if (strcmp(str, n->num) == 0)
- /* match found */
- break;
- nexthsh = n;
- NextString = n->num;
-}
-
-
-
-
-
-
- void
-Lexinit()
-/* Function: Initialization of lexical analyzer:
- * initializes the hashtable,
- * initializes nextc, nexttok if finptr != 0
- */
-{ register int c;
-
- for (c = hshsize; 0 <= --c; ) {
- hshtab[c] = 0;
- }
-
- nerror = 0;
- if (finptr) {
- foutptr = 0;
- hshenter = true;
- ignored_phrases = false;
- rcsline = 1;
- bufrealloc(&tokbuf, 2);
- Iget_(finptr, nextc)
- nextlex(); /*initial token*/
- }
-}
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- void
-nextlex()
-
-/* Function: Reads the next token and sets nexttok to the next token code.
- * Only if hshenter is set, a revision number is entered into the
- * hashtable and a pointer to it is placed into nexthsh.
- * This is useful for avoiding that dates are placed into the hashtable.
- * For ID's and NUM's, NextString is set to the character string.
- * Assumption: nextc contains the next character.
- */
-{ register c;
- declarecache;
- register FILE *frew;
- register char * sp;
- char const *limit;
- register enum tokens d;
- register RILE *fin;
-
- fin=finptr; frew=foutptr;
- setupcache(fin); cache(fin);
- c = nextc;
-
- for (;;) { switch ((d = ctab[c])) {
-
- default:
- fatserror("unknown character `%c'", c);
- /*NOTREACHED*/
-
- case NEWLN:
- ++rcsline;
-# ifdef LEXDB
- afputc('\n',stdout);
-# endif
- /* Note: falls into next case */
-
- case SPACE:
- GETC_(frew, c)
- continue;
-
- case IDCHAR:
- case LETTER:
- case Letter:
- d = ID;
- /* fall into */
- case DIGIT:
- case PERIOD:
- sp = tokbuf.string;
- limit = sp + tokbuf.size;
- *sp++ = c;
- for (;;) {
- GETC_(frew, c)
- switch (ctab[c]) {
- case IDCHAR:
- case LETTER:
- case Letter:
- d = ID;
- /* fall into */
- case DIGIT:
- case PERIOD:
- *sp++ = c;
- if (limit <= sp)
- sp = bufenlarge(&tokbuf, &limit);
- continue;
-
- default:
- break;
- }
- break;
- }
- *sp = 0;
- if (d == DIGIT || d == PERIOD) {
- d = NUM;
- if (hshenter) {
- lookup(tokbuf.string);
- break;
- }
- }
- NextString = fstr_save(tokbuf.string);
- break;
-
- case SBEGIN: /* long string */
- d = STRING;
- /* note: only the initial SBEGIN has been read*/
- /* read the string, and reset nextc afterwards*/
- break;
-
- case COLON:
- case SEMI:
- GETC_(frew, c)
- break;
- } break; }
- nextc = c;
- nexttok = d;
- uncache(fin);
-}
-
- int
-eoflex()
-/*
- * Yield true if we look ahead to the end of the input, false otherwise.
- * nextc becomes undefined at end of file.
- */
-{
- register int c;
- declarecache;
- register FILE *fout;
- register RILE *fin;
-
- c = nextc;
- fin = finptr;
- fout = foutptr;
- setupcache(fin); cache(fin);
-
- for (;;) {
- switch (ctab[c]) {
- default:
- nextc = c;
- uncache(fin);
- return false;
-
- case NEWLN:
- ++rcsline;
- /* fall into */
- case SPACE:
- cachegeteof_(c, {uncache(fin);return true;})
- break;
- }
- if (fout)
- aputc_(c, fout)
- }
-}
-
-
-int getlex(token)
-enum tokens token;
-/* Function: Checks if nexttok is the same as token. If so,
- * advances the input by calling nextlex and returns true.
- * otherwise returns false.
- * Doesn't work for strings and keywords; loses the character string for ids.
- */
-{
- if (nexttok==token) {
- nextlex();
- return(true);
- } else return(false);
-}
-
- int
-getkeyopt(key)
- char const *key;
-/* Function: If the current token is a keyword identical to key,
- * advances the input by calling nextlex and returns true;
- * otherwise returns false.
- */
-{
- if (nexttok==ID && strcmp(key,NextString) == 0) {
- /* match found */
- ffree1(NextString);
- nextlex();
- return(true);
- }
- return(false);
-}
-
- void
-getkey(key)
- char const *key;
-/* Check that the current input token is a keyword identical to key,
- * and advance the input by calling nextlex.
- */
-{
- if (!getkeyopt(key))
- fatserror("missing '%s' keyword", key);
-}
-
- void
-getkeystring(key)
- char const *key;
-/* Check that the current input token is a keyword identical to key,
- * and advance the input by calling nextlex; then look ahead for a string.
- */
-{
- getkey(key);
- if (nexttok != STRING)
- fatserror("missing string after '%s' keyword", key);
-}
-
-
- char const *
-getid()
-/* Function: Checks if nexttok is an identifier. If so,
- * advances the input by calling nextlex and returns a pointer
- * to the identifier; otherwise returns 0.
- * Treats keywords as identifiers.
- */
-{
- register char const *name;
- if (nexttok==ID) {
- name = NextString;
- nextlex();
- return name;
- } else
- return 0;
-}
-
-
-struct hshentry * getnum()
-/* Function: Checks if nexttok is a number. If so,
- * advances the input by calling nextlex and returns a pointer
- * to the hashtable entry. Otherwise returns 0.
- * Doesn't work if hshenter is false.
- */
-{
- register struct hshentry * num;
- if (nexttok==NUM) {
- num=nexthsh;
- nextlex();
- return num;
- } else
- return 0;
-}
-
- struct cbuf
-getphrases(key)
- char const *key;
-/*
-* Get a series of phrases that do not start with KEY. Yield resulting buffer.
-* Stop when the next phrase starts with a token that is not an identifier,
-* or is KEY. Copy input to foutptr if it is set. Unlike ignorephrases(),
-* this routine assumes nextlex() has already been invoked before we start.
-*/
-{
- declarecache;
- register int c;
- register char const *kn;
- struct cbuf r;
- register RILE *fin;
- register FILE *frew;
-# if large_memory
-# define savech_(c) ;
-# else
- register char *p;
- char const *limit;
- struct buf b;
-# define savech_(c) {if (limit<=p)p=bufenlarge(&b,&limit); *p++ =(c);}
-# endif
-
- if (nexttok!=ID || strcmp(NextString,key) == 0)
- clear_buf(&r);
- else {
- warnignore();
- fin = finptr;
- frew = foutptr;
- setupcache(fin); cache(fin);
-# if large_memory
- r.string = (char const*)cacheptr() - strlen(NextString) - 1;
-# else
- bufautobegin(&b);
- bufscpy(&b, NextString);
- p = b.string + strlen(b.string);
- limit = b.string + b.size;
-# endif
- ffree1(NextString);
- c = nextc;
- for (;;) {
- for (;;) {
- savech_(c)
- switch (ctab[c]) {
- default:
- fatserror("unknown character `%c'", c);
- /*NOTREACHED*/
- case NEWLN:
- ++rcsline;
- /* fall into */
- case COLON: case DIGIT: case LETTER: case Letter:
- case PERIOD: case SPACE:
- GETC_(frew, c)
- continue;
- case SBEGIN: /* long string */
- for (;;) {
- for (;;) {
- GETC_(frew, c)
- savech_(c)
- switch (c) {
- case '\n':
- ++rcsline;
- /* fall into */
- default:
- continue;
-
- case SDELIM:
- break;
- }
- break;
- }
- GETC_(frew, c)
- if (c != SDELIM)
- break;
- savech_(c)
- }
- continue;
- case SEMI:
- cacheget_(c)
- if (ctab[c] == NEWLN) {
- if (frew)
- aputc_(c, frew)
- ++rcsline;
- savech_(c)
- cacheget_(c)
- }
-# if large_memory
- r.size = (char const*)cacheptr() - 1 - r.string;
-# endif
- for (;;) {
- switch (ctab[c]) {
- case NEWLN:
- ++rcsline;
- /* fall into */
- case SPACE:
- cacheget_(c)
- continue;
-
- default: break;
- }
- break;
- }
- if (frew)
- aputc_(c, frew)
- break;
- }
- break;
- }
- if (ctab[c] == Letter) {
- for (kn = key; c && *kn==c; kn++)
- GETC_(frew, c)
- if (!*kn)
- switch (ctab[c]) {
- case DIGIT: case LETTER: case Letter:
- case IDCHAR: case PERIOD:
- break;
- default:
- nextc = c;
- NextString = fstr_save(key);
- nexttok = ID;
- uncache(fin);
- goto returnit;
- }
-# if !large_memory
- {
- register char const *ki;
- for (ki=key; ki<kn; )
- savech_(*ki++)
- }
-# endif
- } else {
- nextc = c;
- uncache(fin);
- nextlex();
- break;
- }
- }
- returnit:;
-# if !large_memory
- return bufremember(&b, (size_t)(p - b.string));
-# endif
- }
- return r;
-}
-
-
- void
-readstring()
-/* skip over characters until terminating single SDELIM */
-/* If foutptr is set, copy every character read to foutptr. */
-/* Does not advance nextlex at the end. */
-{ register c;
- declarecache;
- register FILE *frew;
- register RILE *fin;
- fin=finptr; frew=foutptr;
- setupcache(fin); cache(fin);
- for (;;) {
- GETC_(frew, c)
- switch (c) {
- case '\n':
- ++rcsline;
- break;
-
- case SDELIM:
- GETC_(frew, c)
- if (c != SDELIM) {
- /* end of string */
- nextc = c;
- uncache(fin);
- return;
- }
- break;
- }
- }
-}
-
-
- void
-printstring()
-/* Function: copy a string to stdout, until terminated with a single SDELIM.
- * Does not advance nextlex at the end.
- */
-{
- register c;
- declarecache;
- register FILE *fout;
- register RILE *fin;
- fin=finptr;
- fout = stdout;
- setupcache(fin); cache(fin);
- for (;;) {
- cacheget_(c)
- switch (c) {
- case '\n':
- ++rcsline;
- break;
- case SDELIM:
- cacheget_(c)
- if (c != SDELIM) {
- nextc=c;
- uncache(fin);
- return;
- }
- break;
- }
- aputc_(c,fout)
- }
-}
-
-
-
- struct cbuf
-savestring(target)
- struct buf *target;
-/* Copies a string terminated with SDELIM from file finptr to buffer target.
- * Double SDELIM is replaced with SDELIM.
- * If foutptr is set, the string is also copied unchanged to foutptr.
- * Does not advance nextlex at the end.
- * Yield a copy of *TARGET, except with exact length.
- */
-{
- register c;
- declarecache;
- register FILE *frew;
- register char *tp;
- register RILE *fin;
- char const *limit;
- struct cbuf r;
-
- fin=finptr; frew=foutptr;
- setupcache(fin); cache(fin);
- tp = target->string; limit = tp + target->size;
- for (;;) {
- GETC_(frew, c)
- switch (c) {
- case '\n':
- ++rcsline;
- break;
- case SDELIM:
- GETC_(frew, c)
- if (c != SDELIM) {
- /* end of string */
- nextc=c;
- r.string = target->string;
- r.size = tp - r.string;
- uncache(fin);
- return r;
- }
- break;
- }
- if (tp == limit)
- tp = bufenlarge(target, &limit);
- *tp++ = c;
- }
-}
-
-
- static char *
-checkidentifier(id, delimiter, dotok)
- register char *id;
- int delimiter;
- register int dotok;
-/* Function: check whether the string starting at id is an */
-/* identifier and return a pointer to the delimiter*/
-/* after the identifier. White space, delim and 0 */
-/* are legal delimiters. Aborts the program if not*/
-/* a legal identifier. Useful for checking commands*/
-/* If !delim, the only delimiter is 0. */
-/* Allow '.' in identifier only if DOTOK is set. */
-{
- register char *temp;
- register char c;
- register char delim = delimiter;
- int isid = false;
-
- temp = id;
- for (;; id++) {
- switch (ctab[(unsigned char)(c = *id)]) {
- case IDCHAR:
- case LETTER:
- case Letter:
- isid = true;
- continue;
-
- case DIGIT:
- continue;
-
- case PERIOD:
- if (dotok)
- continue;
- break;
-
- default:
- break;
- }
- break;
- }
- if ( ! isid
- || (c && (!delim || (c!=delim && c!=' ' && c!='\t' && c!='\n')))
- ) {
- /* append \0 to end of id before error message */
- while ((c = *id) && c!=' ' && c!='\t' && c!='\n' && c!=delim)
- id++;
- *id = '\0';
- faterror("invalid %s `%s'",
- dotok ? "identifier" : "symbol", temp
- );
- }
- return id;
-}
-
- char *
-checkid(id, delimiter)
- char *id;
- int delimiter;
-{
- return checkidentifier(id, delimiter, true);
-}
-
- char *
-checksym(sym, delimiter)
- char *sym;
- int delimiter;
-{
- return checkidentifier(sym, delimiter, false);
-}
-
- void
-checksid(id)
- char *id;
-/* Check whether the string ID is an identifier. */
-{
- VOID checkid(id, 0);
-}
-
- void
-checkssym(sym)
- char *sym;
-{
- VOID checksym(sym, 0);
-}
-
-
-#if !large_memory
-# define Iclose(f) fclose(f)
-#else
-# if !maps_memory
- static int Iclose P((RILE *));
- static int
- Iclose(f)
- register RILE *f;
- {
- tfree(f->base);
- f->base = 0;
- return fclose(f->stream);
- }
-# else
- static int Iclose P((RILE *));
- static int
- Iclose(f)
- register RILE *f;
- {
- (* f->deallocate) (f);
- f->base = 0;
- return close(f->fd);
- }
-
-# if has_map_fd
- static void map_fd_deallocate P((RILE *));
- static void
- map_fd_deallocate(f)
- register RILE *f;
- {
- if (vm_deallocate(
- task_self(),
- (vm_address_t) f->base,
- (vm_size_t) (f->lim - f->base)
- ) != KERN_SUCCESS)
- efaterror("vm_deallocate");
- }
-# endif
-# if has_mmap
- static void mmap_deallocate P((RILE *));
- static void
- mmap_deallocate(f)
- register RILE *f;
- {
- if (munmap((char *) f->base, (size_t) (f->lim - f->base)) != 0)
- efaterror("munmap");
- }
-# endif
- static void read_deallocate P((RILE *));
- static void
- read_deallocate(f)
- RILE *f;
- {
- tfree(f->base);
- }
-
- static void nothing_to_deallocate P((RILE *));
- static void
- nothing_to_deallocate(f)
- RILE *f;
- {
- }
-# endif
-#endif
-
-
-#if large_memory && maps_memory
- static RILE *fd2_RILE P((int,char const*,struct stat*));
- static RILE *
-fd2_RILE(fd, name, status)
-#else
- static RILE *fd2RILE P((int,char const*,char const*,struct stat*));
- static RILE *
-fd2RILE(fd, name, type, status)
- char const *type;
-#endif
- int fd;
- char const *name;
- register struct stat *status;
-{
- struct stat st;
-
- if (!status)
- status = &st;
- if (fstat(fd, status) != 0)
- efaterror(name);
- if (!S_ISREG(status->st_mode)) {
- error("`%s' is not a regular file", name);
- VOID close(fd);
- errno = EINVAL;
- return 0;
- } else {
-
-# if !(large_memory && maps_memory)
- FILE *stream;
- if (!(stream = fdopen(fd, type)))
- efaterror(name);
-# endif
-
-# if !large_memory
- return stream;
-# else
-# define RILES 3
- {
- static RILE rilebuf[RILES];
-
- register RILE *f;
- size_t s = status->st_size;
-
- if (s != status->st_size)
- faterror("%s: too large", name);
- for (f = rilebuf; f->base; f++)
- if (f == rilebuf+RILES)
- faterror("too many RILEs");
-# if maps_memory
- f->deallocate = nothing_to_deallocate;
-# endif
- if (!s) {
- static unsigned char nothing;
- f->base = &nothing; /* Any nonzero address will do. */
- } else {
- f->base = 0;
-# if has_map_fd
- map_fd(
- fd, (vm_offset_t)0, (vm_address_t*) &f->base,
- TRUE, (vm_size_t)s
- );
- f->deallocate = map_fd_deallocate;
-# endif
-# if has_mmap
- if (!f->base) {
- catchmmapints();
- f->base = (unsigned char *) mmap(
- (char *)0, s, PROT_READ, MAP_SHARED,
- fd, (off_t)0
- );
-# ifndef MAP_FAILED
-# define MAP_FAILED (-1)
-# endif
- if (f->base == (unsigned char *) MAP_FAILED)
- f->base = 0;
- else {
-# if has_NFS && mmap_signal
- /*
- * On many hosts, the superuser
- * can mmap an NFS file it can't read.
- * So access the first page now, and print
- * a nice message if a bus error occurs.
- */
- readAccessFilenameBuffer(name, f->base);
-# endif
- }
- f->deallocate = mmap_deallocate;
- }
-# endif
- if (!f->base) {
- f->base = tnalloc(unsigned char, s);
-# if maps_memory
- {
- /*
- * We can't map the file into memory for some reason.
- * Read it into main memory all at once; this is
- * the simplest substitute for memory mapping.
- */
- char *bufptr = (char *) f->base;
- size_t bufsiz = s;
- do {
- ssize_t r = read(fd, bufptr, bufsiz);
- switch (r) {
- case -1:
- efaterror(name);
-
- case 0:
- /* The file must have shrunk! */
- status->st_size = s -= bufsiz;
- bufsiz = 0;
- break;
-
- default:
- bufptr += r;
- bufsiz -= r;
- break;
- }
- } while (bufsiz);
- if (lseek(fd, (off_t)0, SEEK_SET) == -1)
- efaterror(name);
- f->deallocate = read_deallocate;
- }
-# endif
- }
- }
- f->ptr = f->base;
- f->lim = f->base + s;
- f->fd = fd;
-# if !maps_memory
- f->readlim = f->base;
- f->stream = stream;
-# endif
- if_advise_access(s, f, MADV_SEQUENTIAL);
- return f;
- }
-# endif
- }
-}
-
-#if !maps_memory && large_memory
- int
-Igetmore(f)
- register RILE *f;
-{
- register fread_type r;
- register size_t s = f->lim - f->readlim;
-
- if (BUFSIZ < s)
- s = BUFSIZ;
- if (!(r = Fread(f->readlim, sizeof(*f->readlim), s, f->stream))) {
- testIerror(f->stream);
- f->lim = f->readlim; /* The file might have shrunk! */
- return 0;
- }
- f->readlim += r;
- return 1;
-}
-#endif
-
-#if has_madvise && has_mmap && large_memory
- void
-advise_access(f, advice)
- register RILE *f;
- int advice;
-{
- if (f->deallocate == mmap_deallocate)
- VOID madvise((char *)f->base, (size_t)(f->lim - f->base), advice);
- /* Don't worry if madvise fails; it's only advisory. */
-}
-#endif
-
- RILE *
-#if large_memory && maps_memory
-I_open(name, status)
-#else
-Iopen(name, type, status)
- char const *type;
-#endif
- char const *name;
- struct stat *status;
-/* Open NAME for reading, yield its descriptor, and set *STATUS. */
-{
- int fd = fdSafer(open(name, O_RDONLY
-# if OPEN_O_BINARY
- | (strchr(type,'b') ? OPEN_O_BINARY : 0)
-# endif
- ));
-
- if (fd < 0)
- return 0;
-# if large_memory && maps_memory
- return fd2_RILE(fd, name, status);
-# else
- return fd2RILE(fd, name, type, status);
-# endif
-}
-
-
-static int Oerrloop;
-
- void
-Oerror()
-{
- if (Oerrloop)
- exiterr();
- Oerrloop = true;
- efaterror("output error");
-}
-
-void Ieof() { fatserror("unexpected end of file"); }
-void Ierror() { efaterror("input error"); }
-void testIerror(f) FILE *f; { if (ferror(f)) Ierror(); }
-void testOerror(o) FILE *o; { if (ferror(o)) Oerror(); }
-
-void Ifclose(f) RILE *f; { if (f && Iclose(f)!=0) Ierror(); }
-void Ofclose(f) FILE *f; { if (f && fclose(f)!=0) Oerror(); }
-void Izclose(p) RILE **p; { Ifclose(*p); *p = 0; }
-void Ozclose(p) FILE **p; { Ofclose(*p); *p = 0; }
-
-#if !large_memory
- void
-testIeof(f)
- FILE *f;
-{
- testIerror(f);
- if (feof(f))
- Ieof();
-}
-void Irewind(f) FILE *f; { if (fseek(f,0L,SEEK_SET) != 0) Ierror(); }
-#endif
-
-void Orewind(f) FILE *f; { if (fseek(f,0L,SEEK_SET) != 0) Oerror(); }
-
-void aflush(f) FILE *f; { if (fflush(f) != 0) Oerror(); }
-void eflush() { if (fflush(stderr)!=0 && !Oerrloop) Oerror(); }
-void oflush()
-{
- if (fflush(workstdout ? workstdout : stdout) != 0 && !Oerrloop)
- Oerror();
-}
-
- void
-fatcleanup(already_newline)
- int already_newline;
-{
- VOID fprintf(stderr, already_newline+"\n%s aborted\n", cmdid);
- exiterr();
-}
-
- static void
-startsay(s, t)
- const char *s, *t;
-{
- oflush();
- if (s)
- aprintf(stderr, "%s: %s: %s", cmdid, s, t);
- else
- aprintf(stderr, "%s: %s", cmdid, t);
-}
-
- static void
-fatsay(s)
- char const *s;
-{
- startsay(s, "");
-}
-
- static void
-errsay(s)
- char const *s;
-{
- fatsay(s);
- nerror++;
-}
-
- static void
-warnsay(s)
- char const *s;
-{
- startsay(s, "warning: ");
-}
-
-void eerror(s) char const *s; { enerror(errno,s); }
-
- void
-enerror(e,s)
- int e;
- char const *s;
-{
- errsay((char const*)0);
- errno = e;
- perror(s);
- eflush();
-}
-
-void efaterror(s) char const *s; { enfaterror(errno,s); }
-
- void
-enfaterror(e,s)
- int e;
- char const *s;
-{
- fatsay((char const*)0);
- errno = e;
- perror(s);
- fatcleanup(true);
-}
-
-#if has_prototypes
- void
-error(char const *format,...)
-#else
- /*VARARGS1*/ void error(format, va_alist) char const *format; va_dcl
-#endif
-/* non-fatal error */
-{
- va_list args;
- errsay((char const*)0);
- vararg_start(args, format);
- fvfprintf(stderr, format, args);
- va_end(args);
- afputc('\n',stderr);
- eflush();
-}
-
-#if has_prototypes
- void
-rcserror(char const *format,...)
-#else
- /*VARARGS1*/ void rcserror(format, va_alist) char const *format; va_dcl
-#endif
-/* non-fatal RCS file error */
-{
- va_list args;
- errsay(RCSname);
- vararg_start(args, format);
- fvfprintf(stderr, format, args);
- va_end(args);
- afputc('\n',stderr);
- eflush();
-}
-
-#if has_prototypes
- void
-workerror(char const *format,...)
-#else
- /*VARARGS1*/ void workerror(format, va_alist) char const *format; va_dcl
-#endif
-/* non-fatal working file error */
-{
- va_list args;
- errsay(workname);
- vararg_start(args, format);
- fvfprintf(stderr, format, args);
- va_end(args);
- afputc('\n',stderr);
- eflush();
-}
-
-#if has_prototypes
- void
-fatserror(char const *format,...)
-#else
- /*VARARGS1*/ void
- fatserror(format, va_alist) char const *format; va_dcl
-#endif
-/* fatal RCS file syntax error */
-{
- va_list args;
- oflush();
- VOID fprintf(stderr, "%s: %s:%ld: ", cmdid, RCSname, rcsline);
- vararg_start(args, format);
- fvfprintf(stderr, format, args);
- va_end(args);
- fatcleanup(false);
-}
-
-#if has_prototypes
- void
-faterror(char const *format,...)
-#else
- /*VARARGS1*/ void faterror(format, va_alist)
- char const *format; va_dcl
-#endif
-/* fatal error, terminates program after cleanup */
-{
- va_list args;
- fatsay((char const*)0);
- vararg_start(args, format);
- fvfprintf(stderr, format, args);
- va_end(args);
- fatcleanup(false);
-}
-
-#if has_prototypes
- void
-rcsfaterror(char const *format,...)
-#else
- /*VARARGS1*/ void rcsfaterror(format, va_alist)
- char const *format; va_dcl
-#endif
-/* fatal RCS file error, terminates program after cleanup */
-{
- va_list args;
- fatsay(RCSname);
- vararg_start(args, format);
- fvfprintf(stderr, format, args);
- va_end(args);
- fatcleanup(false);
-}
-
-#if has_prototypes
- void
-warn(char const *format,...)
-#else
- /*VARARGS1*/ void warn(format, va_alist) char const *format; va_dcl
-#endif
-/* warning */
-{
- va_list args;
- if (!quietflag) {
- warnsay((char *)0);
- vararg_start(args, format);
- fvfprintf(stderr, format, args);
- va_end(args);
- afputc('\n', stderr);
- eflush();
- }
-}
-
-#if has_prototypes
- void
-rcswarn(char const *format,...)
-#else
- /*VARARGS1*/ void rcswarn(format, va_alist) char const *format; va_dcl
-#endif
-/* RCS file warning */
-{
- va_list args;
- if (!quietflag) {
- warnsay(RCSname);
- vararg_start(args, format);
- fvfprintf(stderr, format, args);
- va_end(args);
- afputc('\n', stderr);
- eflush();
- }
-}
-
-#if has_prototypes
- void
-workwarn(char const *format,...)
-#else
- /*VARARGS1*/ void workwarn(format, va_alist) char const *format; va_dcl
-#endif
-/* working file warning */
-{
- va_list args;
- if (!quietflag) {
- warnsay(workname);
- vararg_start(args, format);
- fvfprintf(stderr, format, args);
- va_end(args);
- afputc('\n', stderr);
- eflush();
- }
-}
-
- void
-redefined(c)
- int c;
-{
- warn("redefinition of -%c option", c);
-}
-
-#if has_prototypes
- void
-diagnose(char const *format,...)
-#else
- /*VARARGS1*/ void diagnose(format, va_alist) char const *format; va_dcl
-#endif
-/* prints a diagnostic message */
-/* Unlike the other routines, it does not append a newline. */
-/* This lets some callers suppress the newline, and is faster */
-/* in implementations that flush stderr just at the end of each printf. */
-{
- va_list args;
- if (!quietflag) {
- oflush();
- vararg_start(args, format);
- fvfprintf(stderr, format, args);
- va_end(args);
- eflush();
- }
-}
-
-
-
- void
-afputc(c, f)
-/* afputc(c,f); acts like aputc_(c,f) but is smaller and slower. */
- int c;
- register FILE *f;
-{
- aputc_(c,f)
-}
-
-
- void
-aputs(s, iop)
- char const *s;
- FILE *iop;
-/* Function: Put string s on file iop, abort on error.
- */
-{
-#if has_fputs
- if (fputs(s, iop) < 0)
- Oerror();
-#else
- awrite(s, strlen(s), iop);
-#endif
-}
-
-
-
- void
-#if has_prototypes
-fvfprintf(FILE *stream, char const *format, va_list args)
-#else
- fvfprintf(stream,format,args) FILE *stream; char *format; va_list args;
-#endif
-/* like vfprintf, except abort program on error */
-{
-#if has_vfprintf
- if (vfprintf(stream, format, args) < 0)
- Oerror();
-#else
-# if has__doprintf
- _doprintf(stream, format, args);
-# else
-# if has__doprnt
- _doprnt(format, args, stream);
-# else
- int *a = (int *)args;
- VOID fprintf(stream, format,
- a[0], a[1], a[2], a[3], a[4],
- a[5], a[6], a[7], a[8], a[9]
- );
-# endif
-# endif
- if (ferror(stream))
- Oerror();
-#endif
-}
-
-#if has_prototypes
- void
-aprintf(FILE *iop, char const *fmt, ...)
-#else
- /*VARARGS2*/ void
-aprintf(iop, fmt, va_alist)
-FILE *iop;
-char const *fmt;
-va_dcl
-#endif
-/* Function: formatted output. Same as fprintf in stdio,
- * but aborts program on error
- */
-{
- va_list ap;
- vararg_start(ap, fmt);
- fvfprintf(iop, fmt, ap);
- va_end(ap);
-}
-
-
-
-#ifdef LEXDB
-/* test program reading a stream of lexemes and printing the tokens.
- */
-
-
-
- int
-main(argc,argv)
-int argc; char * argv[];
-{
- cmdid="lextest";
- if (argc<2) {
- aputs("No input file\n",stderr);
- exitmain(EXIT_FAILURE);
- }
- if (!(finptr=Iopen(argv[1], FOPEN_R, (struct stat*)0))) {
- faterror("can't open input file %s",argv[1]);
- }
- Lexinit();
- while (!eoflex()) {
- switch (nexttok) {
-
- case ID:
- VOID printf("ID: %s",NextString);
- break;
-
- case NUM:
- if (hshenter)
- VOID printf("NUM: %s, index: %d",nexthsh->num, nexthsh-hshtab);
- else
- VOID printf("NUM, unentered: %s",NextString);
- hshenter = !hshenter; /*alternate between dates and numbers*/
- break;
-
- case COLON:
- VOID printf("COLON"); break;
-
- case SEMI:
- VOID printf("SEMI"); break;
-
- case STRING:
- readstring();
- VOID printf("STRING"); break;
-
- case UNKN:
- VOID printf("UNKN"); break;
-
- default:
- VOID printf("DEFAULT"); break;
- }
- VOID printf(" | ");
- nextlex();
- }
- exitmain(EXIT_SUCCESS);
-}
-
-void exiterr() { _exit(EXIT_FAILURE); }
-
-
-#endif
diff --git a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsmap.c b/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsmap.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 89fb08d..0000000
--- a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsmap.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,69 +0,0 @@
-/* RCS map of character types */
-
-/* Copyright (C) 1982, 1988, 1989 Walter Tichy
- Copyright 1990, 1991, 1995 by Paul Eggert
- Distributed under license by the Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-
-This file is part of RCS.
-
-RCS is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
-it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
-any later version.
-
-RCS is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
-GNU General Public License for more details.
-
-You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-along with RCS; see the file COPYING.
-If not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
-59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
-
-Report problems and direct all questions to:
-
- rcs-bugs@cs.purdue.edu
-
-*/
-
-#include "rcsbase.h"
-
-libId(mapId, "$FreeBSD$")
-
-/* map of character types */
-/* ISO 8859/1 (Latin-1) */
-enum tokens const ctab[] = {
- UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN,
- SPACE, SPACE, NEWLN, SPACE, SPACE, SPACE, UNKN, UNKN,
- UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN,
- UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN,
- SPACE, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, DELIM, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR,
- IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, DELIM, IDCHAR, PERIOD, IDCHAR,
- DIGIT, DIGIT, DIGIT, DIGIT, DIGIT, DIGIT, DIGIT, DIGIT,
- DIGIT, DIGIT, COLON, SEMI, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR,
- SBEGIN, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER,
- LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER,
- LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER,
- LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR,
- IDCHAR, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter,
- Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter,
- Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter,
- Letter, Letter, Letter, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, UNKN,
- UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN,
- UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN,
- UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN,
- UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN, UNKN,
- IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR,
- IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR,
- IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR,
- IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR, IDCHAR,
- LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER,
- LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER,
- LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, IDCHAR,
- LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, Letter,
- Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter,
- Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter,
- Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, IDCHAR,
- Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter, Letter
-};
diff --git a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsrev.c b/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsrev.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 12c6c43..0000000
--- a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsrev.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,911 +0,0 @@
-/* Handle RCS revision numbers. */
-
-/* Copyright 1982, 1988, 1989 Walter Tichy
- Copyright 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995 Paul Eggert
- Distributed under license by the Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-
-This file is part of RCS.
-
-RCS is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
-it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
-any later version.
-
-RCS is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
-GNU General Public License for more details.
-
-You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-along with RCS; see the file COPYING.
-If not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
-59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
-
-Report problems and direct all questions to:
-
- rcs-bugs@cs.purdue.edu
-
-*/
-
-/*
- * Revision 5.10 1995/06/16 06:19:24 eggert
- * Update FSF address.
- *
- * Revision 5.9 1995/06/01 16:23:43 eggert
- * (cmpdate, normalizeyear): New functions work around MKS RCS incompatibility.
- * (cmpnum, compartial): s[d] -> *(s+d) to work around Cray compiler bug.
- * (genrevs, genbranch): cmpnum -> cmpdate
- *
- * Revision 5.8 1994/03/17 14:05:48 eggert
- * Remove lint.
- *
- * Revision 5.7 1993/11/09 17:40:15 eggert
- * Fix format string typos.
- *
- * Revision 5.6 1993/11/03 17:42:27 eggert
- * Revision number `.N' now stands for `D.N', where D is the default branch.
- * Add -z. Improve quality of diagnostics. Add `namedrev' for Name support.
- *
- * Revision 5.5 1992/07/28 16:12:44 eggert
- * Identifiers may now start with a digit. Avoid `unsigned'.
- *
- * Revision 5.4 1992/01/06 02:42:34 eggert
- * while (E) ; -> while (E) continue;
- *
- * Revision 5.3 1991/08/19 03:13:55 eggert
- * Add `-r$', `-rB.'. Remove botches like `<now>' from messages. Tune.
- *
- * Revision 5.2 1991/04/21 11:58:28 eggert
- * Add tiprev().
- *
- * Revision 5.1 1991/02/25 07:12:43 eggert
- * Avoid overflow when comparing revision numbers.
- *
- * Revision 5.0 1990/08/22 08:13:43 eggert
- * Remove compile-time limits; use malloc instead.
- * Ansify and Posixate. Tune.
- * Remove possibility of an internal error. Remove lint.
- *
- * Revision 4.5 89/05/01 15:13:22 narten
- * changed copyright header to reflect current distribution rules
- *
- * Revision 4.4 87/12/18 11:45:22 narten
- * more lint cleanups. Also, the NOTREACHED comment is no longer necessary,
- * since there's now a return value there with a value. (Guy Harris)
- *
- * Revision 4.3 87/10/18 10:38:42 narten
- * Updating version numbers. Changes relative to version 1.1 actually
- * relative to 4.1
- *
- * Revision 1.3 87/09/24 14:00:37 narten
- * Sources now pass through lint (if you ignore printf/sprintf/fprintf
- * warnings)
- *
- * Revision 1.2 87/03/27 14:22:37 jenkins
- * Port to suns
- *
- * Revision 4.1 83/03/25 21:10:45 wft
- * Only changed $Header to $Id.
- *
- * Revision 3.4 82/12/04 13:24:08 wft
- * Replaced getdelta() with gettree().
- *
- * Revision 3.3 82/11/28 21:33:15 wft
- * fixed compartial() and compnum() for nil-parameters; fixed nils
- * in error messages. Testprogram output shortenend.
- *
- * Revision 3.2 82/10/18 21:19:47 wft
- * renamed compnum->cmpnum, compnumfld->cmpnumfld,
- * numericrevno->numricrevno.
- *
- * Revision 3.1 82/10/11 19:46:09 wft
- * changed expandsym() to check for source==nil; returns zero length string
- * in that case.
- */
-
-#include "rcsbase.h"
-
-libId(revId, "$FreeBSD$")
-
-static char const *branchtip P((char const*));
-static char const *lookupsym P((char const*));
-static char const *normalizeyear P((char const*,char[5]));
-static struct hshentry *genbranch P((struct hshentry const*,char const*,int,char const*,char const*,char const*,struct hshentries**));
-static void absent P((char const*,int));
-static void cantfindbranch P((char const*,char const[datesize],char const*,char const*));
-static void store1 P((struct hshentries***,struct hshentry*));
-
-
-
- int
-countnumflds(s)
- char const *s;
-/* Given a pointer s to a dotted number (date or revision number),
- * countnumflds returns the number of digitfields in s.
- */
-{
- register char const *sp;
- register int count;
- if (!(sp=s) || !*sp)
- return 0;
- count = 1;
- do {
- if (*sp++ == '.') count++;
- } while (*sp);
- return(count);
-}
-
- void
-getbranchno(revno,branchno)
- char const *revno;
- struct buf *branchno;
-/* Given a revision number revno, getbranchno copies the number of the branch
- * on which revno is into branchno. If revno itself is a branch number,
- * it is copied unchanged.
- */
-{
- register int numflds;
- register char *tp;
-
- bufscpy(branchno, revno);
- numflds=countnumflds(revno);
- if (!(numflds & 1)) {
- tp = branchno->string;
- while (--numflds)
- while (*tp++ != '.')
- continue;
- *(tp-1)='\0';
- }
-}
-
-
-
-int cmpnum(num1, num2)
- char const *num1, *num2;
-/* compares the two dotted numbers num1 and num2 lexicographically
- * by field. Individual fields are compared numerically.
- * returns <0, 0, >0 if num1<num2, num1==num2, and num1>num2, resp.
- * omitted fields are assumed to be higher than the existing ones.
-*/
-{
- register char const *s1, *s2;
- register size_t d1, d2;
- register int r;
-
- s1 = num1 ? num1 : "";
- s2 = num2 ? num2 : "";
-
- for (;;) {
- /* Give precedence to shorter one. */
- if (!*s1)
- return (unsigned char)*s2;
- if (!*s2)
- return -1;
-
- /* Strip leading zeros, then find number of digits. */
- while (*s1=='0') ++s1;
- while (*s2=='0') ++s2;
- for (d1=0; isdigit(*(s1+d1)); d1++) continue;
- for (d2=0; isdigit(*(s2+d2)); d2++) continue;
-
- /* Do not convert to integer; it might overflow! */
- if (d1 != d2)
- return d1<d2 ? -1 : 1;
- if ((r = memcmp(s1, s2, d1)))
- return r;
- s1 += d1;
- s2 += d1;
-
- /* skip '.' */
- if (*s1) s1++;
- if (*s2) s2++;
- }
-}
-
-
-
-int cmpnumfld(num1, num2, fld)
- char const *num1, *num2;
- int fld;
-/* Compare the two dotted numbers at field fld.
- * num1 and num2 must have at least fld fields.
- * fld must be positive.
-*/
-{
- register char const *s1, *s2;
- register size_t d1, d2;
-
- s1 = num1;
- s2 = num2;
- /* skip fld-1 fields */
- while (--fld) {
- while (*s1++ != '.')
- continue;
- while (*s2++ != '.')
- continue;
- }
- /* Now s1 and s2 point to the beginning of the respective fields */
- while (*s1=='0') ++s1; for (d1=0; isdigit(*(s1+d1)); d1++) continue;
- while (*s2=='0') ++s2; for (d2=0; isdigit(*(s2+d2)); d2++) continue;
-
- return d1<d2 ? -1 : d1==d2 ? memcmp(s1,s2,d1) : 1;
-}
-
-
- int
-cmpdate(d1, d2)
- char const *d1, *d2;
-/*
-* Compare the two dates. This is just like cmpnum,
-* except that for compatibility with old versions of RCS,
-* 1900 is added to dates with two-digit years.
-*/
-{
- char year1[5], year2[5];
- int r = cmpnumfld(normalizeyear(d1,year1), normalizeyear(d2,year2), 1);
-
- if (r)
- return r;
- else {
- while (isdigit(*d1)) d1++; d1 += *d1=='.';
- while (isdigit(*d2)) d2++; d2 += *d2=='.';
- return cmpnum(d1, d2);
- }
-}
-
- static char const *
-normalizeyear(date, year)
- char const *date;
- char year[5];
-{
- if (isdigit(date[0]) && isdigit(date[1]) && !isdigit(date[2])) {
- year[0] = '1';
- year[1] = '9';
- year[2] = date[0];
- year[3] = date[1];
- year[4] = 0;
- return year;
- } else
- return date;
-}
-
-
- static void
-cantfindbranch(revno, date, author, state)
- char const *revno, date[datesize], *author, *state;
-{
- char datebuf[datesize + zonelenmax];
-
- rcserror("No revision on branch %s has%s%s%s%s%s%s.",
- revno,
- date ? " a date before " : "",
- date ? date2str(date,datebuf) : "",
- author ? " and author "+(date?0:4) : "",
- author ? author : "",
- state ? " and state "+(date||author?0:4) : "",
- state ? state : ""
- );
-}
-
- static void
-absent(revno, field)
- char const *revno;
- int field;
-{
- struct buf t;
- bufautobegin(&t);
- rcserror("%s %s absent", field&1?"revision":"branch",
- partialno(&t,revno,field)
- );
- bufautoend(&t);
-}
-
-
- int
-compartial(num1, num2, length)
- char const *num1, *num2;
- int length;
-
-/* compare the first "length" fields of two dot numbers;
- the omitted field is considered to be larger than any number */
-/* restriction: at least one number has length or more fields */
-
-{
- register char const *s1, *s2;
- register size_t d1, d2;
- register int r;
-
- s1 = num1; s2 = num2;
- if (!s1) return 1;
- if (!s2) return -1;
-
- for (;;) {
- if (!*s1) return 1;
- if (!*s2) return -1;
-
- while (*s1=='0') ++s1; for (d1=0; isdigit(*(s1+d1)); d1++) continue;
- while (*s2=='0') ++s2; for (d2=0; isdigit(*(s2+d2)); d2++) continue;
-
- if (d1 != d2)
- return d1<d2 ? -1 : 1;
- if ((r = memcmp(s1, s2, d1)))
- return r;
- if (!--length)
- return 0;
-
- s1 += d1;
- s2 += d1;
-
- if (*s1 == '.') s1++;
- if (*s2 == '.') s2++;
- }
-}
-
-
-char * partialno(rev1,rev2,length)
- struct buf *rev1;
- char const *rev2;
- register int length;
-/* Function: Copies length fields of revision number rev2 into rev1.
- * Return rev1's string.
- */
-{
- register char *r1;
-
- bufscpy(rev1, rev2);
- r1 = rev1->string;
- while (length) {
- while (*r1!='.' && *r1)
- ++r1;
- ++r1;
- length--;
- }
- /* eliminate last '.'*/
- *(r1-1)='\0';
- return rev1->string;
-}
-
-
-
-
- static void
-store1(store, next)
- struct hshentries ***store;
- struct hshentry *next;
-/*
- * Allocate a new list node that addresses NEXT.
- * Append it to the list that **STORE is the end pointer of.
- */
-{
- register struct hshentries *p;
-
- p = ftalloc(struct hshentries);
- p->first = next;
- **store = p;
- *store = &p->rest;
-}
-
-struct hshentry * genrevs(revno,date,author,state,store)
- char const *revno, *date, *author, *state;
- struct hshentries **store;
-/* Function: finds the deltas needed for reconstructing the
- * revision given by revno, date, author, and state, and stores pointers
- * to these deltas into a list whose starting address is given by store.
- * The last delta (target delta) is returned.
- * If the proper delta could not be found, 0 is returned.
- */
-{
- int length;
- register struct hshentry * next;
- int result;
- char const *branchnum;
- struct buf t;
- char datebuf[datesize + zonelenmax];
-
- bufautobegin(&t);
-
- if (!(next = Head)) {
- rcserror("RCS file empty");
- goto norev;
- }
-
- length = countnumflds(revno);
-
- if (length >= 1) {
- /* at least one field; find branch exactly */
- while ((result=cmpnumfld(revno,next->num,1)) < 0) {
- store1(&store, next);
- next = next->next;
- if (!next) {
- rcserror("branch number %s too low", partialno(&t,revno,1));
- goto norev;
- }
- }
-
- if (result>0) {
- absent(revno, 1);
- goto norev;
- }
- }
- if (length<=1){
- /* pick latest one on given branch */
- branchnum = next->num; /* works even for empty revno*/
- while (next &&
- cmpnumfld(branchnum,next->num,1) == 0 &&
- (
- (date && cmpdate(date,next->date) < 0) ||
- (author && strcmp(author,next->author) != 0) ||
- (state && strcmp(state,next->state) != 0)
- )
- )
- {
- store1(&store, next);
- next=next->next;
- }
- if (!next ||
- (cmpnumfld(branchnum,next->num,1)!=0))/*overshot*/ {
- cantfindbranch(
- length ? revno : partialno(&t,branchnum,1),
- date, author, state
- );
- goto norev;
- } else {
- store1(&store, next);
- }
- *store = 0;
- return next;
- }
-
- /* length >=2 */
- /* find revision; may go low if length==2*/
- while ((result=cmpnumfld(revno,next->num,2)) < 0 &&
- (cmpnumfld(revno,next->num,1)==0) ) {
- store1(&store, next);
- next = next->next;
- if (!next)
- break;
- }
-
- if (!next || cmpnumfld(revno,next->num,1) != 0) {
- rcserror("revision number %s too low", partialno(&t,revno,2));
- goto norev;
- }
- if ((length>2) && (result!=0)) {
- absent(revno, 2);
- goto norev;
- }
-
- /* print last one */
- store1(&store, next);
-
- if (length>2)
- return genbranch(next,revno,length,date,author,state,store);
- else { /* length == 2*/
- if (date && cmpdate(date,next->date)<0) {
- rcserror("Revision %s has date %s.",
- next->num,
- date2str(next->date, datebuf)
- );
- return 0;
- }
- if (author && strcmp(author,next->author)!=0) {
- rcserror("Revision %s has author %s.",
- next->num, next->author
- );
- return 0;
- }
- if (state && strcmp(state,next->state)!=0) {
- rcserror("Revision %s has state %s.",
- next->num,
- next->state ? next->state : "<empty>"
- );
- return 0;
- }
- *store = 0;
- return next;
- }
-
- norev:
- bufautoend(&t);
- return 0;
-}
-
-
-
-
- static struct hshentry *
-genbranch(bpoint, revno, length, date, author, state, store)
- struct hshentry const *bpoint;
- char const *revno;
- int length;
- char const *date, *author, *state;
- struct hshentries **store;
-/* Function: given a branchpoint, a revision number, date, author, and state,
- * genbranch finds the deltas necessary to reconstruct the given revision
- * from the branch point on.
- * Pointers to the found deltas are stored in a list beginning with store.
- * revno must be on a side branch.
- * Return 0 on error.
- */
-{
- int field;
- register struct hshentry * next, * trail;
- register struct branchhead const *bhead;
- int result;
- struct buf t;
- char datebuf[datesize + zonelenmax];
-
- field = 3;
- bhead = bpoint->branches;
-
- do {
- if (!bhead) {
- bufautobegin(&t);
- rcserror("no side branches present for %s",
- partialno(&t,revno,field-1)
- );
- bufautoend(&t);
- return 0;
- }
-
- /*find branch head*/
- /*branches are arranged in increasing order*/
- while (0 < (result=cmpnumfld(revno,bhead->hsh->num,field))) {
- bhead = bhead->nextbranch;
- if (!bhead) {
- bufautobegin(&t);
- rcserror("branch number %s too high",
- partialno(&t,revno,field)
- );
- bufautoend(&t);
- return 0;
- }
- }
-
- if (result<0) {
- absent(revno, field);
- return 0;
- }
-
- next = bhead->hsh;
- if (length==field) {
- /* pick latest one on that branch */
- trail = 0;
- do { if ((!date || cmpdate(date,next->date)>=0) &&
- (!author || strcmp(author,next->author)==0) &&
- (!state || strcmp(state,next->state)==0)
- ) trail = next;
- next=next->next;
- } while (next);
-
- if (!trail) {
- cantfindbranch(revno, date, author, state);
- return 0;
- } else { /* print up to last one suitable */
- next = bhead->hsh;
- while (next!=trail) {
- store1(&store, next);
- next=next->next;
- }
- store1(&store, next);
- }
- *store = 0;
- return next;
- }
-
- /* length > field */
- /* find revision */
- /* check low */
- if (cmpnumfld(revno,next->num,field+1)<0) {
- bufautobegin(&t);
- rcserror("revision number %s too low",
- partialno(&t,revno,field+1)
- );
- bufautoend(&t);
- return 0;
- }
- do {
- store1(&store, next);
- trail = next;
- next = next->next;
- } while (next && cmpnumfld(revno,next->num,field+1)>=0);
-
- if ((length>field+1) && /*need exact hit */
- (cmpnumfld(revno,trail->num,field+1) !=0)){
- absent(revno, field+1);
- return 0;
- }
- if (length == field+1) {
- if (date && cmpdate(date,trail->date)<0) {
- rcserror("Revision %s has date %s.",
- trail->num,
- date2str(trail->date, datebuf)
- );
- return 0;
- }
- if (author && strcmp(author,trail->author)!=0) {
- rcserror("Revision %s has author %s.",
- trail->num, trail->author
- );
- return 0;
- }
- if (state && strcmp(state,trail->state)!=0) {
- rcserror("Revision %s has state %s.",
- trail->num,
- trail->state ? trail->state : "<empty>"
- );
- return 0;
- }
- }
- bhead = trail->branches;
-
- } while ((field+=2) <= length);
- *store = 0;
- return trail;
-}
-
-
- static char const *
-lookupsym(id)
- char const *id;
-/* Function: looks up id in the list of symbolic names starting
- * with pointer SYMBOLS, and returns a pointer to the corresponding
- * revision number. Return 0 if not present.
- */
-{
- register struct assoc const *next;
- for (next = Symbols; next; next = next->nextassoc)
- if (strcmp(id, next->symbol)==0)
- return next->num;
- return 0;
-}
-
-int expandsym(source, target)
- char const *source;
- struct buf *target;
-/* Function: Source points to a revision number. Expandsym copies
- * the number to target, but replaces all symbolic fields in the
- * source number with their numeric values.
- * Expand a branch followed by `.' to the latest revision on that branch.
- * Ignore `.' after a revision. Remove leading zeros.
- * returns false on error;
- */
-{
- return fexpandsym(source, target, (RILE*)0);
-}
-
- int
-fexpandsym(source, target, fp)
- char const *source;
- struct buf *target;
- RILE *fp;
-/* Same as expandsym, except if FP is nonzero, it is used to expand KDELIM. */
-{
- register char const *sp, *bp;
- register char *tp;
- char const *tlim;
- int dots;
-
- sp = source;
- bufalloc(target, 1);
- tp = target->string;
- if (!sp || !*sp) { /* Accept 0 pointer as a legal value. */
- *tp='\0';
- return true;
- }
- if (sp[0] == KDELIM && !sp[1]) {
- if (!getoldkeys(fp))
- return false;
- if (!*prevrev.string) {
- workerror("working file lacks revision number");
- return false;
- }
- bufscpy(target, prevrev.string);
- return true;
- }
- tlim = tp + target->size;
- dots = 0;
-
- for (;;) {
- register char *p = tp;
- size_t s = tp - target->string;
- int id = false;
- for (;;) {
- switch (ctab[(unsigned char)*sp]) {
- case IDCHAR:
- case LETTER:
- case Letter:
- id = true;
- /* fall into */
- case DIGIT:
- if (tlim <= p)
- p = bufenlarge(target, &tlim);
- *p++ = *sp++;
- continue;
-
- default:
- break;
- }
- break;
- }
- if (tlim <= p)
- p = bufenlarge(target, &tlim);
- *p = 0;
- tp = target->string + s;
-
- if (id) {
- bp = lookupsym(tp);
- if (!bp) {
- rcserror("Symbolic name `%s' is undefined.",tp);
- return false;
- }
- } else {
- /* skip leading zeros */
- for (bp = tp; *bp=='0' && isdigit(bp[1]); bp++)
- continue;
-
- if (!*bp)
- if (s || *sp!='.')
- break;
- else {
- /* Insert default branch before initial `.'. */
- char const *b;
- if (Dbranch)
- b = Dbranch;
- else if (Head)
- b = Head->num;
- else
- break;
- getbranchno(b, target);
- bp = tp = target->string;
- tlim = tp + target->size;
- }
- }
-
- while ((*tp++ = *bp++))
- if (tlim <= tp)
- tp = bufenlarge(target, &tlim);
-
- switch (*sp++) {
- case '\0':
- return true;
-
- case '.':
- if (!*sp) {
- if (dots & 1)
- break;
- if (!(bp = branchtip(target->string)))
- return false;
- bufscpy(target, bp);
- return true;
- }
- ++dots;
- tp[-1] = '.';
- continue;
- }
- break;
- }
-
- rcserror("improper revision number: %s", source);
- return false;
-}
-
- char const *
-namedrev(name, delta)
- char const *name;
- struct hshentry *delta;
-/* Yield NAME if it names DELTA, 0 otherwise. */
-{
- if (name) {
- char const *id = 0, *p, *val;
- for (p = name; ; p++)
- switch (ctab[(unsigned char)*p]) {
- case IDCHAR:
- case LETTER:
- case Letter:
- id = name;
- break;
-
- case DIGIT:
- break;
-
- case UNKN:
- if (!*p && id &&
- (val = lookupsym(id)) &&
- strcmp(val, delta->num) == 0
- )
- return id;
- /* fall into */
- default:
- return 0;
- }
- }
- return 0;
-}
-
- static char const *
-branchtip(branch)
- char const *branch;
-{
- struct hshentry *h;
- struct hshentries *hs;
-
- h = genrevs(branch, (char*)0, (char*)0, (char*)0, &hs);
- return h ? h->num : (char const*)0;
-}
-
- char const *
-tiprev()
-{
- return Dbranch ? branchtip(Dbranch) : Head ? Head->num : (char const*)0;
-}
-
-
-
-#ifdef REVTEST
-
-/*
-* Test the routines that generate a sequence of delta numbers
-* needed to regenerate a given delta.
-*/
-
-char const cmdid[] = "revtest";
-
- int
-main(argc,argv)
-int argc; char * argv[];
-{
- static struct buf numricrevno;
- char symrevno[100]; /* used for input of revision numbers */
- char author[20];
- char state[20];
- char date[20];
- struct hshentries *gendeltas;
- struct hshentry * target;
- int i;
-
- if (argc<2) {
- aputs("No input file\n",stderr);
- exitmain(EXIT_FAILURE);
- }
- if (!(finptr=Iopen(argv[1], FOPEN_R, (struct stat*)0))) {
- faterror("can't open input file %s", argv[1]);
- }
- Lexinit();
- getadmin();
-
- gettree();
-
- getdesc(false);
-
- do {
- /* all output goes to stderr, to have diagnostics and */
- /* errors in sequence. */
- aputs("\nEnter revision number or <return> or '.': ",stderr);
- if (!fgets(symrevno, 100, stdin)) break;
- if (*symrevno == '.') break;
- aprintf(stderr,"%s;\n",symrevno);
- expandsym(symrevno,&numricrevno);
- aprintf(stderr,"expanded number: %s; ",numricrevno.string);
- aprintf(stderr,"Date: ");
- fgets(date, 20, stdin); aprintf(stderr,"%s; ",date);
- aprintf(stderr,"Author: ");
- fgets(author, 20, stdin); aprintf(stderr,"%s; ",author);
- aprintf(stderr,"State: ");
- fgets(state, 20, stdin); aprintf(stderr, "%s;\n", state);
- target = genrevs(numricrevno.string, *date?date:(char *)0, *author?author:(char *)0,
- *state?state:(char*)0, &gendeltas);
- if (target) {
- while (gendeltas) {
- aprintf(stderr,"%s\n",gendeltas->first->num);
- gendeltas = gendeltas->next;
- }
- }
- } while (true);
- aprintf(stderr,"done\n");
- exitmain(EXIT_SUCCESS);
-}
-
-void exiterr() { _exit(EXIT_FAILURE); }
-
-#endif
diff --git a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcssyn.c b/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcssyn.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 07f155b..0000000
--- a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcssyn.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,681 +0,0 @@
-/* RCS file syntactic analysis */
-
-/******************************************************************************
- * Syntax Analysis.
- * Keyword table
- * Testprogram: define SYNTEST
- * Compatibility with Release 2: define COMPAT2=1
- ******************************************************************************
- */
-
-/* Copyright 1982, 1988, 1989 Walter Tichy
- Copyright 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995 Paul Eggert
- Distributed under license by the Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-
-This file is part of RCS.
-
-RCS is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
-it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
-any later version.
-
-RCS is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
-GNU General Public License for more details.
-
-You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-along with RCS; see the file COPYING.
-If not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
-59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
-
-Report problems and direct all questions to:
-
- rcs-bugs@cs.purdue.edu
-
-*/
-
-/*
- * Revision 5.15 1995/06/16 06:19:24 eggert
- * Update FSF address.
- *
- * Revision 5.14 1995/06/01 16:23:43 eggert
- * (expand_names): Add "b" for -kb.
- * (getdelta): Don't strip leading "19" from MKS RCS dates; see cmpdate.
- *
- * Revision 5.13 1994/03/20 04:52:58 eggert
- * Remove lint.
- *
- * Revision 5.12 1993/11/03 17:42:27 eggert
- * Parse MKS RCS dates; ignore \r in diff control lines.
- * Don't discard ignored phrases. Improve quality of diagnostics.
- *
- * Revision 5.11 1992/07/28 16:12:44 eggert
- * Avoid `unsigned'. Statement macro names now end in _.
- *
- * Revision 5.10 1992/01/24 18:44:19 eggert
- * Move put routines to rcsgen.c.
- *
- * Revision 5.9 1992/01/06 02:42:34 eggert
- * ULONG_MAX/10 -> ULONG_MAX_OVER_10
- * while (E) ; -> while (E) continue;
- *
- * Revision 5.8 1991/08/19 03:13:55 eggert
- * Tune.
- *
- * Revision 5.7 1991/04/21 11:58:29 eggert
- * Disambiguate names on shortname hosts.
- * Fix errno bug. Add MS-DOS support.
- *
- * Revision 5.6 1991/02/28 19:18:51 eggert
- * Fix null termination bug in reporting keyword expansion.
- *
- * Revision 5.5 1991/02/25 07:12:44 eggert
- * Check diff output more carefully; avoid overflow.
- *
- * Revision 5.4 1990/11/01 05:28:48 eggert
- * When ignoring unknown phrases, copy them to the output RCS file.
- * Permit arbitrary data in logs and comment leaders.
- * Don't check for nontext on initial checkin.
- *
- * Revision 5.3 1990/09/20 07:58:32 eggert
- * Remove the test for non-text bytes; it caused more pain than it cured.
- *
- * Revision 5.2 1990/09/04 08:02:30 eggert
- * Parse RCS files with no revisions.
- * Don't strip leading white space from diff commands. Count RCS lines better.
- *
- * Revision 5.1 1990/08/29 07:14:06 eggert
- * Add -kkvl. Clean old log messages too.
- *
- * Revision 5.0 1990/08/22 08:13:44 eggert
- * Try to parse future RCS formats without barfing.
- * Add -k. Don't require final newline.
- * Remove compile-time limits; use malloc instead.
- * Don't output branch keyword if there's no default branch,
- * because RCS version 3 doesn't understand it.
- * Tune. Remove lint.
- * Add support for ISO 8859. Ansify and Posixate.
- * Check that a newly checked-in file is acceptable as input to 'diff'.
- * Check diff's output.
- *
- * Revision 4.6 89/05/01 15:13:32 narten
- * changed copyright header to reflect current distribution rules
- *
- * Revision 4.5 88/08/09 19:13:21 eggert
- * Allow cc -R; remove lint.
- *
- * Revision 4.4 87/12/18 11:46:16 narten
- * more lint cleanups (Guy Harris)
- *
- * Revision 4.3 87/10/18 10:39:36 narten
- * Updating version numbers. Changes relative to 1.1 actually relative to
- * 4.1
- *
- * Revision 1.3 87/09/24 14:00:49 narten
- * Sources now pass through lint (if you ignore printf/sprintf/fprintf
- * warnings)
- *
- * Revision 1.2 87/03/27 14:22:40 jenkins
- * Port to suns
- *
- * Revision 4.1 83/03/28 11:38:49 wft
- * Added parsing and printing of default branch.
- *
- * Revision 3.6 83/01/15 17:46:50 wft
- * Changed readdelta() to initialize selector and log-pointer.
- * Changed puttree to check for selector==DELETE; putdtext() uses DELNUMFORM.
- *
- * Revision 3.5 82/12/08 21:58:58 wft
- * renamed Commentleader to Commleader.
- *
- * Revision 3.4 82/12/04 13:24:40 wft
- * Added routine gettree(), which updates keeplock after reading the
- * delta tree.
- *
- * Revision 3.3 82/11/28 21:30:11 wft
- * Reading and printing of Suffix removed; version COMPAT2 skips the
- * Suffix for files of release 2 format. Fixed problems with printing nil.
- *
- * Revision 3.2 82/10/18 21:18:25 wft
- * renamed putdeltatext to putdtext.
- *
- * Revision 3.1 82/10/11 19:45:11 wft
- * made sure getc() returns into an integer.
- */
-
-
-
-/* version COMPAT2 reads files of the format of release 2 and 3, but
- * generates files of release 3 format. Need not be defined if no
- * old RCS files generated with release 2 exist.
- */
-
-#include "rcsbase.h"
-
-libId(synId, "$FreeBSD$")
-
-static char const *getkeyval P((char const*,enum tokens,int));
-static int getdelta P((void));
-static int strn2expmode P((char const*,size_t));
-static struct hshentry *getdnum P((void));
-static void badDiffOutput P((char const*)) exiting;
-static void diffLineNumberTooLarge P((char const*)) exiting;
-static void getsemi P((char const*));
-
-/* keyword table */
-
-char const
- Kaccess[] = "access",
- Kauthor[] = "author",
- Kbranch[] = "branch",
- Kcomment[] = "comment",
- Kdate[] = "date",
- Kdesc[] = "desc",
- Kexpand[] = "expand",
- Khead[] = "head",
- Klocks[] = "locks",
- Klog[] = "log",
- Knext[] = "next",
- Kstate[] = "state",
- Kstrict[] = "strict",
- Ksymbols[] = "symbols",
- Ktext[] = "text";
-
-static char const
-#if COMPAT2
- Ksuffix[] = "suffix",
-#endif
- K_branches[]= "branches";
-
-static struct buf Commleader;
-struct cbuf Comment;
-struct cbuf Ignored;
-struct access * AccessList;
-struct assoc * Symbols;
-struct rcslock *Locks;
-int Expand;
-int StrictLocks;
-struct hshentry * Head;
-char const * Dbranch;
-int TotalDeltas;
-
-
- static void
-getsemi(key)
- char const *key;
-/* Get a semicolon to finish off a phrase started by KEY. */
-{
- if (!getlex(SEMI))
- fatserror("missing ';' after '%s'", key);
-}
-
- static struct hshentry *
-getdnum()
-/* Get a delta number. */
-{
- register struct hshentry *delta = getnum();
- if (delta && countnumflds(delta->num)&1)
- fatserror("%s isn't a delta number", delta->num);
- return delta;
-}
-
-
- void
-getadmin()
-/* Read an <admin> and initialize the appropriate global variables. */
-{
- register char const *id;
- struct access * newaccess;
- struct assoc * newassoc;
- struct rcslock *newlock;
- struct hshentry * delta;
- struct access **LastAccess;
- struct assoc **LastSymbol;
- struct rcslock **LastLock;
- struct buf b;
- struct cbuf cb;
-
- TotalDeltas=0;
-
- getkey(Khead);
- Head = getdnum();
- getsemi(Khead);
-
- Dbranch = 0;
- if (getkeyopt(Kbranch)) {
- if ((delta = getnum()))
- Dbranch = delta->num;
- getsemi(Kbranch);
- }
-
-
-#if COMPAT2
- /* read suffix. Only in release 2 format */
- if (getkeyopt(Ksuffix)) {
- if (nexttok==STRING) {
- readstring(); nextlex(); /* Throw away the suffix. */
- } else if (nexttok==ID) {
- nextlex();
- }
- getsemi(Ksuffix);
- }
-#endif
-
- getkey(Kaccess);
- LastAccess = &AccessList;
- while ((id = getid())) {
- newaccess = ftalloc(struct access);
- newaccess->login = id;
- *LastAccess = newaccess;
- LastAccess = &newaccess->nextaccess;
- }
- *LastAccess = 0;
- getsemi(Kaccess);
-
- getkey(Ksymbols);
- LastSymbol = &Symbols;
- while ((id = getid())) {
- if (!getlex(COLON))
- fatserror("missing ':' in symbolic name definition");
- if (!(delta=getnum())) {
- fatserror("missing number in symbolic name definition");
- } else { /*add new pair to association list*/
- newassoc = ftalloc(struct assoc);
- newassoc->symbol=id;
- newassoc->num = delta->num;
- *LastSymbol = newassoc;
- LastSymbol = &newassoc->nextassoc;
- }
- }
- *LastSymbol = 0;
- getsemi(Ksymbols);
-
- getkey(Klocks);
- LastLock = &Locks;
- while ((id = getid())) {
- if (!getlex(COLON))
- fatserror("missing ':' in lock");
- if (!(delta=getdnum())) {
- fatserror("missing number in lock");
- } else { /*add new pair to lock list*/
- newlock = ftalloc(struct rcslock);
- newlock->login=id;
- newlock->delta=delta;
- *LastLock = newlock;
- LastLock = &newlock->nextlock;
- }
- }
- *LastLock = 0;
- getsemi(Klocks);
-
- if ((StrictLocks = getkeyopt(Kstrict)))
- getsemi(Kstrict);
-
- clear_buf(&Comment);
- if (getkeyopt(Kcomment)) {
- if (nexttok==STRING) {
- Comment = savestring(&Commleader);
- nextlex();
- }
- getsemi(Kcomment);
- }
-
- Expand = KEYVAL_EXPAND;
- if (getkeyopt(Kexpand)) {
- if (nexttok==STRING) {
- bufautobegin(&b);
- cb = savestring(&b);
- if ((Expand = strn2expmode(cb.string,cb.size)) < 0)
- fatserror("unknown expand mode %.*s",
- (int)cb.size, cb.string
- );
- bufautoend(&b);
- nextlex();
- }
- getsemi(Kexpand);
- }
- Ignored = getphrases(Kdesc);
-}
-
-char const *const expand_names[] = {
- /* These must agree with *_EXPAND in rcsbase.h. */
- "kv", "kvl", "k", "v", "o", "b",
- 0
-};
-
- int
-str2expmode(s)
- char const *s;
-/* Yield expand mode corresponding to S, or -1 if bad. */
-{
- return strn2expmode(s, strlen(s));
-}
-
- static int
-strn2expmode(s, n)
- char const *s;
- size_t n;
-{
- char const *const *p;
-
- for (p = expand_names; *p; ++p)
- if (memcmp(*p,s,n) == 0 && !(*p)[n])
- return p - expand_names;
- return -1;
-}
-
-
- void
-ignorephrases(key)
- const char *key;
-/*
-* Ignore a series of phrases that do not start with KEY.
-* Stop when the next phrase starts with a token that is not an identifier,
-* or is KEY.
-*/
-{
- for (;;) {
- nextlex();
- if (nexttok != ID || strcmp(NextString,key) == 0)
- break;
- warnignore();
- hshenter=false;
- for (;; nextlex()) {
- switch (nexttok) {
- case SEMI: hshenter=true; break;
- case ID:
- case NUM: ffree1(NextString); continue;
- case STRING: readstring(); continue;
- default: continue;
- }
- break;
- }
- }
-}
-
-
- static int
-getdelta()
-/* Function: reads a delta block.
- * returns false if the current block does not start with a number.
- */
-{
- register struct hshentry * Delta, * num;
- struct branchhead **LastBranch, *NewBranch;
-
- if (!(Delta = getdnum()))
- return false;
-
- hshenter = false; /*Don't enter dates into hashtable*/
- Delta->date = getkeyval(Kdate, NUM, false);
- hshenter=true; /*reset hshenter for revision numbers.*/
-
- Delta->author = getkeyval(Kauthor, ID, false);
-
- Delta->state = getkeyval(Kstate, ID, true);
-
- getkey(K_branches);
- LastBranch = &Delta->branches;
- while ((num = getdnum())) {
- NewBranch = ftalloc(struct branchhead);
- NewBranch->hsh = num;
- *LastBranch = NewBranch;
- LastBranch = &NewBranch->nextbranch;
- }
- *LastBranch = 0;
- getsemi(K_branches);
-
- getkey(Knext);
- Delta->next = num = getdnum();
- getsemi(Knext);
- Delta->lockedby = 0;
- Delta->log.string = 0;
- Delta->selector = true;
- Delta->ig = getphrases(Kdesc);
- TotalDeltas++;
- return (true);
-}
-
-
- void
-gettree()
-/* Function: Reads in the delta tree with getdelta(), then
- * updates the lockedby fields.
- */
-{
- struct rcslock const *currlock;
-
- while (getdelta())
- continue;
- currlock=Locks;
- while (currlock) {
- currlock->delta->lockedby = currlock->login;
- currlock = currlock->nextlock;
- }
-}
-
-
- void
-getdesc(prdesc)
-int prdesc;
-/* Function: read in descriptive text
- * nexttok is not advanced afterwards.
- * If prdesc is set, the text is printed to stdout.
- */
-{
-
- getkeystring(Kdesc);
- if (prdesc)
- printstring(); /*echo string*/
- else readstring(); /*skip string*/
-}
-
-
-
-
-
-
- static char const *
-getkeyval(keyword, token, optional)
- char const *keyword;
- enum tokens token;
- int optional;
-/* reads a pair of the form
- * <keyword> <token> ;
- * where token is one of <id> or <num>. optional indicates whether
- * <token> is optional. A pointer to
- * the actual character string of <id> or <num> is returned.
- */
-{
- register char const *val = 0;
-
- getkey(keyword);
- if (nexttok==token) {
- val = NextString;
- nextlex();
- } else {
- if (!optional)
- fatserror("missing %s", keyword);
- }
- getsemi(keyword);
- return(val);
-}
-
-
- void
-unexpected_EOF()
-{
- rcsfaterror("unexpected EOF in diff output");
-}
-
- void
-initdiffcmd(dc)
- register struct diffcmd *dc;
-/* Initialize *dc suitably for getdiffcmd(). */
-{
- dc->adprev = 0;
- dc->dafter = 0;
-}
-
- static void
-badDiffOutput(buf)
- char const *buf;
-{
- rcsfaterror("bad diff output line: %s", buf);
-}
-
- static void
-diffLineNumberTooLarge(buf)
- char const *buf;
-{
- rcsfaterror("diff line number too large: %s", buf);
-}
-
- int
-getdiffcmd(finfile, delimiter, foutfile, dc)
- RILE *finfile;
- FILE *foutfile;
- int delimiter;
- struct diffcmd *dc;
-/* Get a editing command output by 'diff -n' from fin.
- * The input is delimited by SDELIM if delimiter is set, EOF otherwise.
- * Copy a clean version of the command to fout (if nonnull).
- * Yield 0 for 'd', 1 for 'a', and -1 for EOF.
- * Store the command's line number and length into dc->line1 and dc->nlines.
- * Keep dc->adprev and dc->dafter up to date.
- */
-{
- register int c;
- declarecache;
- register FILE *fout;
- register char *p;
- register RILE *fin;
- long line1, nlines, t;
- char buf[BUFSIZ];
-
- fin = finfile;
- fout = foutfile;
- setupcache(fin); cache(fin);
- cachegeteof_(c, { if (delimiter) unexpected_EOF(); return -1; } )
- if (delimiter) {
- if (c==SDELIM) {
- cacheget_(c)
- if (c==SDELIM) {
- buf[0] = c;
- buf[1] = 0;
- badDiffOutput(buf);
- }
- uncache(fin);
- nextc = c;
- if (fout)
- aprintf(fout, "%c%c", SDELIM, c);
- return -1;
- }
- }
- p = buf;
- do {
- if (buf+BUFSIZ-2 <= p) {
- rcsfaterror("diff output command line too long");
- }
- *p++ = c;
- cachegeteof_(c, unexpected_EOF();)
- } while (c != '\n');
- uncache(fin);
- if (delimiter)
- ++rcsline;
- *p = '\0';
- for (p = buf+1; (c = *p++) == ' '; )
- continue;
- line1 = 0;
- while (isdigit(c)) {
- if (
- LONG_MAX/10 < line1 ||
- (t = line1 * 10, (line1 = t + (c - '0')) < t)
- )
- diffLineNumberTooLarge(buf);
- c = *p++;
- }
- while (c == ' ')
- c = *p++;
- nlines = 0;
- while (isdigit(c)) {
- if (
- LONG_MAX/10 < nlines ||
- (t = nlines * 10, (nlines = t + (c - '0')) < t)
- )
- diffLineNumberTooLarge(buf);
- c = *p++;
- }
- if (c == '\r')
- c = *p++;
- if (c || !nlines) {
- badDiffOutput(buf);
- }
- if (line1+nlines < line1)
- diffLineNumberTooLarge(buf);
- switch (buf[0]) {
- case 'a':
- if (line1 < dc->adprev) {
- rcsfaterror("backward insertion in diff output: %s", buf);
- }
- dc->adprev = line1 + 1;
- break;
- case 'd':
- if (line1 < dc->adprev || line1 < dc->dafter) {
- rcsfaterror("backward deletion in diff output: %s", buf);
- }
- dc->adprev = line1;
- dc->dafter = line1 + nlines;
- break;
- default:
- badDiffOutput(buf);
- }
- if (fout) {
- aprintf(fout, "%s\n", buf);
- }
- dc->line1 = line1;
- dc->nlines = nlines;
- return buf[0] == 'a';
-}
-
-
-
-#ifdef SYNTEST
-
-/* Input an RCS file and print its internal data structures. */
-
-char const cmdid[] = "syntest";
-
- int
-main(argc,argv)
-int argc; char * argv[];
-{
-
- if (argc<2) {
- aputs("No input file\n",stderr);
- exitmain(EXIT_FAILURE);
- }
- if (!(finptr = Iopen(argv[1], FOPEN_R, (struct stat*)0))) {
- faterror("can't open input file %s", argv[1]);
- }
- Lexinit();
- getadmin();
- fdlock = STDOUT_FILENO;
- putadmin();
-
- gettree();
-
- getdesc(true);
-
- nextlex();
-
- if (!eoflex()) {
- fatserror("expecting EOF");
- }
- exitmain(EXIT_SUCCESS);
-}
-
-void exiterr() { _exit(EXIT_FAILURE); }
-
-#endif
diff --git a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcstime.c b/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcstime.c
deleted file mode 100644
index cfd4660..0000000
--- a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcstime.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,191 +0,0 @@
-/* Convert between RCS time format and Posix and/or C formats. */
-
-/* Copyright 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995 Paul Eggert
- Distributed under license by the Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-
-This file is part of RCS.
-
-RCS is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
-it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
-any later version.
-
-RCS is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
-GNU General Public License for more details.
-
-You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-along with RCS; see the file COPYING.
-If not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
-59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
-
-Report problems and direct all questions to:
-
- rcs-bugs@cs.purdue.edu
-
-*/
-
-#include "rcsbase.h"
-#include "partime.h"
-#include "maketime.h"
-
-libId(rcstimeId, "$FreeBSD$")
-
-static long zone_offset; /* seconds east of UTC, or TM_LOCAL_ZONE */
-static int use_zone_offset; /* if zero, use UTC without zone indication */
-
-/*
-* Convert Unix time to RCS format.
-* For compatibility with older versions of RCS,
-* dates from 1900 through 1999 are stored without the leading "19".
-*/
- void
-time2date(unixtime,date)
- time_t unixtime;
- char date[datesize];
-{
- register struct tm const *tm = time2tm(unixtime, RCSversion<VERSION(5));
- VOID sprintf(date,
-# if has_printf_dot
- "%.2d.%.2d.%.2d.%.2d.%.2d.%.2d",
-# else
- "%02d.%02d.%02d.%02d.%02d.%02d",
-# endif
- tm->tm_year + ((unsigned)tm->tm_year < 100 ? 0 : 1900),
- tm->tm_mon+1, tm->tm_mday,
- tm->tm_hour, tm->tm_min, tm->tm_sec
- );
-}
-
-/* Like str2time, except die if an error was found. */
-static time_t str2time_checked P((char const*,time_t,long));
- static time_t
-str2time_checked(source, default_time, default_zone)
- char const *source;
- time_t default_time;
- long default_zone;
-{
- time_t t = str2time(source, default_time, default_zone);
- if (t == -1)
- faterror("unknown date/time: %s", source);
- return t;
-}
-
-/*
-* Parse a free-format date in SOURCE, convert it
-* into RCS internal format, and store the result into TARGET.
-*/
- void
-str2date(source, target)
- char const *source;
- char target[datesize];
-{
- time2date(
- str2time_checked(source, now(),
- use_zone_offset ? zone_offset
- : RCSversion<VERSION(5) ? TM_LOCAL_ZONE
- : 0
- ),
- target
- );
-}
-
-/* Convert an RCS internal format date to time_t. */
- time_t
-date2time(source)
- char const source[datesize];
-{
- char s[datesize + zonelenmax];
- return str2time_checked(date2str(source, s), (time_t)0, 0);
-}
-
-
-/* Set the time zone for date2str output. */
- void
-zone_set(s)
- char const *s;
-{
- if ((use_zone_offset = *s)) {
- long zone;
- char const *zonetail = parzone(s, &zone);
- if (!zonetail || *zonetail)
- error("%s: not a known time zone", s);
- else
- zone_offset = zone;
- }
-}
-
-
-/*
-* Format a user-readable form of the RCS format DATE into the buffer DATEBUF.
-* Yield DATEBUF.
-*/
- char const *
-date2str(date, datebuf)
- char const date[datesize];
- char datebuf[datesize + zonelenmax];
-{
- register char const *p = date;
-
- while (*p++ != '.')
- continue;
- if (!use_zone_offset)
- VOID sprintf(datebuf,
- "19%.*s/%.2s/%.2s %.2s:%.2s:%s"
- + (date[2]=='.' && VERSION(5)<=RCSversion ? 0 : 2),
- (int)(p-date-1), date,
- p, p+3, p+6, p+9, p+12
- );
- else {
- struct tm t;
- struct tm const *z;
- int non_hour;
- long zone;
- char c;
-
- t.tm_year = atoi(date) - (date[2]=='.' ? 0 : 1900);
- t.tm_mon = atoi(p) - 1;
- t.tm_mday = atoi(p+3);
- t.tm_hour = atoi(p+6);
- t.tm_min = atoi(p+9);
- t.tm_sec = atoi(p+12);
- t.tm_wday = -1;
- zone = zone_offset;
- if (zone == TM_LOCAL_ZONE) {
- time_t u = tm2time(&t, 0), d;
- z = localtime(&u);
- d = difftm(z, &t);
- zone = (time_t)-1 < 0 || d < -d ? d : -(long)-d;
- } else {
- adjzone(&t, zone);
- z = &t;
- }
- c = '+';
- if (zone < 0) {
- zone = -zone;
- c = '-';
- }
- VOID sprintf(datebuf,
-# if has_printf_dot
- "%.2d-%.2d-%.2d %.2d:%.2d:%.2d%c%.2d",
-# else
- "%02d-%02d-%02d %02d:%02d:%02d%c%02d",
-# endif
- z->tm_year + 1900,
- z->tm_mon + 1, z->tm_mday, z->tm_hour, z->tm_min, z->tm_sec,
- c, (int) (zone / (60*60))
- );
- if ((non_hour = zone % (60*60))) {
-# if has_printf_dot
- static char const fmt[] = ":%.2d";
-# else
- static char const fmt[] = ":%02d";
-# endif
- VOID sprintf(datebuf + strlen(datebuf), fmt, non_hour / 60);
- if ((non_hour %= 60))
- VOID sprintf(datebuf + strlen(datebuf), fmt, non_hour);
- }
- }
- return datebuf;
-}
diff --git a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsutil.c b/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsutil.c
deleted file mode 100644
index e10afff..0000000
--- a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/rcsutil.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,1398 +0,0 @@
-/* RCS utility functions */
-
-/* Copyright 1982, 1988, 1989 Walter Tichy
- Copyright 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995 Paul Eggert
- Distributed under license by the Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-
-This file is part of RCS.
-
-RCS is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
-it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
-any later version.
-
-RCS is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
-GNU General Public License for more details.
-
-You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-along with RCS; see the file COPYING.
-If not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
-59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
-
-Report problems and direct all questions to:
-
- rcs-bugs@cs.purdue.edu
-
-*/
-
-
-
-
-/*
- * Revision 5.20 1995/06/16 06:19:24 eggert
- * (catchsig): Remove `return'.
- * Update FSF address.
- *
- * Revision 5.19 1995/06/02 18:19:00 eggert
- * (catchsigaction): New name for `catchsig', for sa_sigaction signature.
- * Use nRCS even if !has_psiginfo, to remove unused variable warning.
- * (setup_catchsig): Use sa_sigaction only if has_sa_sigaction.
- * Use ENOTSUP only if defined.
- *
- * Revision 5.18 1995/06/01 16:23:43 eggert
- * (catchsig, restoreints, setup_catchsig): Use SA_SIGINFO, not has_psiginfo,
- * to determine whether to use SA_SIGINFO feature,
- * but also check at runtime whether the feature works.
- * (catchsig): If an mmap_signal occurs, report the affected file name.
- * (unsupported_SA_SIGINFO, accessName): New variables.
- * (setup_catchsig): If using SA_SIGINFO, use sa_sigaction, not sa_handler.
- * If SA_SIGINFO fails, fall back on sa_handler method.
- *
- * (readAccessFilenameBuffer, dupSafer, fdSafer, fopenSafer): New functions.
- * (concatenate): Remove.
- *
- * (runv): Work around bad_wait_if_SIGCHLD_ignored bug.
- * Remove reference to OPEN_O_WORK.
- *
- * Revision 5.17 1994/03/20 04:52:58 eggert
- * Specify subprocess input via file descriptor, not file name.
- * Avoid messing with I/O buffers in the child process.
- * Define dup in terms of F_DUPFD if it exists.
- * Move setmtime to rcsedit.c. Remove lint.
- *
- * Revision 5.16 1993/11/09 17:40:15 eggert
- * -V now prints version on stdout and exits.
- *
- * Revision 5.15 1993/11/03 17:42:27 eggert
- * Use psiginfo and setreuid if available. Move date2str to maketime.c.
- *
- * Revision 5.14 1992/07/28 16:12:44 eggert
- * Add -V. has_sigaction overrides sig_zaps_handler. Fix -M bug.
- * Add mmap_signal, which minimizes signal handling for non-mmap hosts.
- *
- * Revision 5.13 1992/02/17 23:02:28 eggert
- * Work around NFS mmap SIGBUS problem. Add -T support.
- *
- * Revision 5.12 1992/01/24 18:44:19 eggert
- * Work around NFS mmap bug that leads to SIGBUS core dumps. lint -> RCS_lint
- *
- * Revision 5.11 1992/01/06 02:42:34 eggert
- * O_BINARY -> OPEN_O_WORK
- * while (E) ; -> while (E) continue;
- *
- * Revision 5.10 1991/10/07 17:32:46 eggert
- * Support piece tables even if !has_mmap.
- *
- * Revision 5.9 1991/08/19 03:13:55 eggert
- * Add spawn() support. Explicate assumptions about getting invoker's name.
- * Standardize user-visible dates. Tune.
- *
- * Revision 5.8 1991/04/21 11:58:30 eggert
- * Plug setuid security hole.
- *
- * Revision 5.6 1991/02/26 17:48:39 eggert
- * Fix setuid bug. Use fread, fwrite more portably.
- * Support waitpid. Don't assume -1 is acceptable to W* macros.
- * strsave -> str_save (DG/UX name clash)
- *
- * Revision 5.5 1990/12/04 05:18:49 eggert
- * Don't output a blank line after a signal diagnostic.
- * Use -I for prompts and -q for diagnostics.
- *
- * Revision 5.4 1990/11/01 05:03:53 eggert
- * Remove unneeded setid check. Add awrite(), fremember().
- *
- * Revision 5.3 1990/10/06 00:16:45 eggert
- * Don't fread F if feof(F).
- *
- * Revision 5.2 1990/09/04 08:02:31 eggert
- * Store fread()'s result in an fread_type object.
- *
- * Revision 5.1 1990/08/29 07:14:07 eggert
- * Declare getpwuid() more carefully.
- *
- * Revision 5.0 1990/08/22 08:13:46 eggert
- * Add setuid support. Permit multiple locks per user.
- * Remove compile-time limits; use malloc instead.
- * Switch to GMT. Permit dates past 1999/12/31.
- * Add -V. Remove snooping. Ansify and Posixate.
- * Tune. Some USG hosts define NSIG but not sys_siglist.
- * Don't run /bin/sh if it's hopeless.
- * Don't leave garbage behind if the output is an empty pipe.
- * Clean up after SIGXCPU or SIGXFSZ. Print name of signal that caused cleanup.
- *
- * Revision 4.6 89/05/01 15:13:40 narten
- * changed copyright header to reflect current distribution rules
- *
- * Revision 4.5 88/11/08 16:01:02 narten
- * corrected use of varargs routines
- *
- * Revision 4.4 88/08/09 19:13:24 eggert
- * Check for memory exhaustion.
- * Permit signal handlers to yield either 'void' or 'int'; fix oldSIGINT botch.
- * Use execv(), not system(); yield exit status like diff(1)'s.
- *
- * Revision 4.3 87/10/18 10:40:22 narten
- * Updating version numbers. Changes relative to 1.1 actually
- * relative to 4.1
- *
- * Revision 1.3 87/09/24 14:01:01 narten
- * Sources now pass through lint (if you ignore printf/sprintf/fprintf
- * warnings)
- *
- * Revision 1.2 87/03/27 14:22:43 jenkins
- * Port to suns
- *
- * Revision 4.1 83/05/10 15:53:13 wft
- * Added getcaller() and findlock().
- * Changed catchints() to check SIGINT for SIG_IGN before setting up the signal
- * (needed for background jobs in older shells). Added restoreints().
- * Removed printing of full RCS path from logcommand().
- *
- * Revision 3.8 83/02/15 15:41:49 wft
- * Added routine fastcopy() to copy remainder of a file in blocks.
- *
- * Revision 3.7 82/12/24 15:25:19 wft
- * added catchints(), ignoreints() for catching and ingnoring interrupts;
- * fixed catchsig().
- *
- * Revision 3.6 82/12/08 21:52:05 wft
- * Using DATEFORM to format dates.
- *
- * Revision 3.5 82/12/04 18:20:49 wft
- * Replaced SNOOPDIR with SNOOPFILE; changed addlock() to update
- * lockedby-field.
- *
- * Revision 3.4 82/12/03 17:17:43 wft
- * Added check to addlock() ensuring only one lock per person.
- * Addlock also returns a pointer to the lock created. Deleted fancydate().
- *
- * Revision 3.3 82/11/27 12:24:37 wft
- * moved rmsema(), trysema(), trydiraccess(), getfullRCSname() to rcsfnms.c.
- * Introduced macro SNOOP so that snoop can be placed in directory other than
- * TARGETDIR. Changed %02d to %.2d for compatibility reasons.
- *
- * Revision 3.2 82/10/18 21:15:11 wft
- * added function getfullRCSname().
- *
- * Revision 3.1 82/10/13 16:17:37 wft
- * Cleanup message is now suppressed in quiet mode.
- */
-
-
-
-
-#include "rcsbase.h"
-
-libId(utilId, "$FreeBSD$")
-
-#if !has_memcmp
- int
-memcmp(s1, s2, n)
- void const *s1, *s2;
- size_t n;
-{
- register unsigned char const
- *p1 = (unsigned char const*)s1,
- *p2 = (unsigned char const*)s2;
- register size_t i = n;
- register int r = 0;
- while (i-- && !(r = (*p1++ - *p2++)))
- ;
- return r;
-}
-#endif
-
-#if !has_memcpy
- void *
-memcpy(s1, s2, n)
- void *s1;
- void const *s2;
- size_t n;
-{
- register char *p1 = (char*)s1;
- register char const *p2 = (char const*)s2;
- while (n--)
- *p1++ = *p2++;
- return s1;
-}
-#endif
-
-#if RCS_lint
- malloc_type lintalloc;
-#endif
-
-/*
- * list of blocks allocated with ftestalloc()
- * These blocks can be freed by ffree when we're done with the current file.
- * We could put the free block inside struct alloclist, rather than a pointer
- * to the free block, but that would be less portable.
- */
-struct alloclist {
- malloc_type alloc;
- struct alloclist *nextalloc;
-};
-static struct alloclist *alloced;
-
-
- static malloc_type okalloc P((malloc_type));
- static malloc_type
-okalloc(p)
- malloc_type p;
-{
- if (!p)
- faterror("out of memory");
- return p;
-}
-
- malloc_type
-testalloc(size)
- size_t size;
-/* Allocate a block, testing that the allocation succeeded. */
-{
- return okalloc(malloc(size));
-}
-
- malloc_type
-testrealloc(ptr, size)
- malloc_type ptr;
- size_t size;
-/* Reallocate a block, testing that the allocation succeeded. */
-{
- return okalloc(realloc(ptr, size));
-}
-
- malloc_type
-fremember(ptr)
- malloc_type ptr;
-/* Remember PTR in 'alloced' so that it can be freed later. Yield PTR. */
-{
- register struct alloclist *q = talloc(struct alloclist);
- q->nextalloc = alloced;
- alloced = q;
- return q->alloc = ptr;
-}
-
- malloc_type
-ftestalloc(size)
- size_t size;
-/* Allocate a block, putting it in 'alloced' so it can be freed later. */
-{
- return fremember(testalloc(size));
-}
-
- void
-ffree()
-/* Free all blocks allocated with ftestalloc(). */
-{
- register struct alloclist *p, *q;
- for (p = alloced; p; p = q) {
- q = p->nextalloc;
- tfree(p->alloc);
- tfree(p);
- }
- alloced = 0;
-}
-
- void
-ffree1(f)
- register char const *f;
-/* Free the block f, which was allocated by ftestalloc. */
-{
- register struct alloclist *p, **a = &alloced;
-
- while ((p = *a)->alloc != f)
- a = &p->nextalloc;
- *a = p->nextalloc;
- tfree(p->alloc);
- tfree(p);
-}
-
- char *
-str_save(s)
- char const *s;
-/* Save s in permanently allocated storage. */
-{
- return strcpy(tnalloc(char, strlen(s)+1), s);
-}
-
- char *
-fstr_save(s)
- char const *s;
-/* Save s in storage that will be deallocated when we're done with this file. */
-{
- return strcpy(ftnalloc(char, strlen(s)+1), s);
-}
-
- char *
-cgetenv(name)
- char const *name;
-/* Like getenv(), but yield a copy; getenv() can overwrite old results. */
-{
- register char *p;
-
- return (p=getenv(name)) ? str_save(p) : p;
-}
-
- char const *
-getusername(suspicious)
- int suspicious;
-/* Get the caller's login name. Trust only getwpuid if SUSPICIOUS. */
-{
- static char *name;
-
- if (!name) {
- if (
- /* Prefer getenv() unless suspicious; it's much faster. */
-# if getlogin_is_secure
- (suspicious
- || (
- !(name = cgetenv("LOGNAME"))
- && !(name = cgetenv("USER"))
- ))
- && !(name = getlogin())
-# else
- suspicious
- || (
- !(name = cgetenv("LOGNAME"))
- && !(name = cgetenv("USER"))
- && !(name = getlogin())
- )
-# endif
- ) {
-#if has_getuid && has_getpwuid
- struct passwd const *pw = getpwuid(ruid());
- if (!pw)
- faterror("no password entry for userid %lu",
- (unsigned long)ruid()
- );
- name = pw->pw_name;
-#else
-#if has_setuid
- faterror("setuid not supported");
-#else
- faterror("Who are you? Please setenv LOGNAME.");
-#endif
-#endif
- }
- checksid(name);
- }
- return name;
-}
-
-
-
-
-#if has_signal
-
-/*
- * Signal handling
- *
- * Standard C places too many restrictions on signal handlers.
- * We obey as many of them as we can.
- * Posix places fewer restrictions, and we are Posix-compatible here.
- */
-
-static sig_atomic_t volatile heldsignal, holdlevel;
-#ifdef SA_SIGINFO
- static int unsupported_SA_SIGINFO;
- static siginfo_t bufsiginfo;
- static siginfo_t *volatile heldsiginfo;
-#endif
-
-
-#if has_NFS && has_mmap && large_memory && mmap_signal
- static char const *accessName;
-
- void
- readAccessFilenameBuffer(filename, p)
- char const *filename;
- unsigned char const *p;
- {
- unsigned char volatile t;
- accessName = filename;
- t = *p;
- accessName = 0;
- }
-#else
-# define accessName ((char const *) 0)
-#endif
-
-
-#if !has_psignal
-
-# define psignal my_psignal
- static void my_psignal P((int,char const*));
- static void
-my_psignal(sig, s)
- int sig;
- char const *s;
-{
- char const *sname = "Unknown signal";
-# if has_sys_siglist && defined(NSIG)
- if ((unsigned)sig < NSIG)
- sname = sys_siglist[sig];
-# else
- switch (sig) {
-# ifdef SIGHUP
- case SIGHUP: sname = "Hangup"; break;
-# endif
-# ifdef SIGINT
- case SIGINT: sname = "Interrupt"; break;
-# endif
-# ifdef SIGPIPE
- case SIGPIPE: sname = "Broken pipe"; break;
-# endif
-# ifdef SIGQUIT
- case SIGQUIT: sname = "Quit"; break;
-# endif
-# ifdef SIGTERM
- case SIGTERM: sname = "Terminated"; break;
-# endif
-# ifdef SIGXCPU
- case SIGXCPU: sname = "Cputime limit exceeded"; break;
-# endif
-# ifdef SIGXFSZ
- case SIGXFSZ: sname = "Filesize limit exceeded"; break;
-# endif
-# if has_mmap && large_memory
-# if defined(SIGBUS) && mmap_signal==SIGBUS
- case SIGBUS: sname = "Bus error"; break;
-# endif
-# if defined(SIGSEGV) && mmap_signal==SIGSEGV
- case SIGSEGV: sname = "Segmentation fault"; break;
-# endif
-# endif
- }
-# endif
-
- /* Avoid calling sprintf etc., in case they're not reentrant. */
- {
- char const *p;
- char buf[BUFSIZ], *b = buf;
- for (p = s; *p; *b++ = *p++)
- continue;
- *b++ = ':';
- *b++ = ' ';
- for (p = sname; *p; *b++ = *p++)
- continue;
- *b++ = '\n';
- VOID write(STDERR_FILENO, buf, b - buf);
- }
-}
-#endif
-
-static signal_type catchsig P((int));
-#ifdef SA_SIGINFO
- static signal_type catchsigaction P((int,siginfo_t*,void*));
-#endif
-
- static signal_type
-catchsig(s)
- int s;
-#ifdef SA_SIGINFO
-{
- catchsigaction(s, (siginfo_t *)0, (void *)0);
-}
- static signal_type
-catchsigaction(s, i, c)
- int s;
- siginfo_t *i;
- void *c;
-#endif
-{
-# if sig_zaps_handler
- /* If a signal arrives before we reset the handler, we lose. */
- VOID signal(s, SIG_IGN);
-# endif
-
-# ifdef SA_SIGINFO
- if (!unsupported_SA_SIGINFO)
- i = 0;
-# endif
-
- if (holdlevel) {
- heldsignal = s;
-# ifdef SA_SIGINFO
- if (i) {
- bufsiginfo = *i;
- heldsiginfo = &bufsiginfo;
- }
-# endif
- return;
- }
-
- ignoreints();
- setrid();
- if (!quietflag) {
- /* Avoid calling sprintf etc., in case they're not reentrant. */
- char const *p;
- char buf[BUFSIZ], *b = buf;
-
- if ( ! (
-# if has_mmap && large_memory && mmap_signal
- /* Check whether this signal was planned. */
- s == mmap_signal && accessName
-# else
- 0
-# endif
- )) {
- char const *nRCS = "\nRCS";
-# if defined(SA_SIGINFO) && has_si_errno && has_mmap && large_memory && mmap_signal
- if (s == mmap_signal && i && i->si_errno) {
- errno = i->si_errno;
- perror(nRCS++);
- }
-# endif
-# if defined(SA_SIGINFO) && has_psiginfo
- if (i)
- psiginfo(i, nRCS);
- else
- psignal(s, nRCS);
-# else
- psignal(s, nRCS);
-# endif
- }
-
- for (p = "RCS: "; *p; *b++ = *p++)
- continue;
-# if has_mmap && large_memory && mmap_signal
- if (s == mmap_signal) {
- p = accessName;
- if (!p)
- p = "Was a file changed by some other process? ";
- else {
- char const *p1;
- for (p1 = p; *p1; p1++)
- continue;
- VOID write(STDERR_FILENO, buf, b - buf);
- VOID write(STDERR_FILENO, p, p1 - p);
- b = buf;
- p = ": Permission denied. ";
- }
- while (*p)
- *b++ = *p++;
- }
-# endif
- for (p = "Cleaning up.\n"; *p; *b++ = *p++)
- continue;
- VOID write(STDERR_FILENO, buf, b - buf);
- }
- exiterr();
-}
-
- void
-ignoreints()
-{
- ++holdlevel;
-}
-
- void
-restoreints()
-{
- if (!--holdlevel && heldsignal)
-# ifdef SA_SIGINFO
- VOID catchsigaction(heldsignal, heldsiginfo, (void *)0);
-# else
- VOID catchsig(heldsignal);
-# endif
-}
-
-
-static void setup_catchsig P((int const*,int));
-
-#if has_sigaction
-
- static void check_sig P((int));
- static void
- check_sig(r)
- int r;
- {
- if (r != 0)
- efaterror("signal handling");
- }
-
- static void
- setup_catchsig(sig, sigs)
- int const *sig;
- int sigs;
- {
- register int i, j;
- struct sigaction act;
-
- for (i=sigs; 0<=--i; ) {
- check_sig(sigaction(sig[i], (struct sigaction*)0, &act));
- if (act.sa_handler != SIG_IGN) {
- act.sa_handler = catchsig;
-# ifdef SA_SIGINFO
- if (!unsupported_SA_SIGINFO) {
-# if has_sa_sigaction
- act.sa_sigaction = catchsigaction;
-# else
- act.sa_handler = catchsigaction;
-# endif
- act.sa_flags |= SA_SIGINFO;
- }
-# endif
- for (j=sigs; 0<=--j; )
- check_sig(sigaddset(&act.sa_mask, sig[j]));
- if (sigaction(sig[i], &act, (struct sigaction*)0) != 0) {
-# if defined(SA_SIGINFO) && defined(ENOTSUP)
- if (errno == ENOTSUP && !unsupported_SA_SIGINFO) {
- /* Turn off use of SA_SIGINFO and try again. */
- unsupported_SA_SIGINFO = 1;
- i++;
- continue;
- }
-# endif
- check_sig(-1);
- }
- }
- }
- }
-
-#else
-#if has_sigblock
-
- static void
- setup_catchsig(sig, sigs)
- int const *sig;
- int sigs;
- {
- register int i;
- int mask;
-
- mask = 0;
- for (i=sigs; 0<=--i; )
- mask |= sigmask(sig[i]);
- mask = sigblock(mask);
- for (i=sigs; 0<=--i; )
- if (
- signal(sig[i], catchsig) == SIG_IGN &&
- signal(sig[i], SIG_IGN) != catchsig
- )
- faterror("signal catcher failure");
- VOID sigsetmask(mask);
- }
-
-#else
-
- static void
- setup_catchsig(sig, sigs)
- int const *sig;
- int sigs;
- {
- register i;
-
- for (i=sigs; 0<=--i; )
- if (
- signal(sig[i], SIG_IGN) != SIG_IGN &&
- signal(sig[i], catchsig) != SIG_IGN
- )
- faterror("signal catcher failure");
- }
-
-#endif
-#endif
-
-
-static int const regsigs[] = {
-# ifdef SIGHUP
- SIGHUP,
-# endif
-# ifdef SIGINT
- SIGINT,
-# endif
-# ifdef SIGPIPE
- SIGPIPE,
-# endif
-# ifdef SIGQUIT
- SIGQUIT,
-# endif
-# ifdef SIGTERM
- SIGTERM,
-# endif
-# ifdef SIGXCPU
- SIGXCPU,
-# endif
-# ifdef SIGXFSZ
- SIGXFSZ,
-# endif
-};
-
- void
-catchints()
-{
- static int catching_ints;
- if (!catching_ints) {
- catching_ints = true;
- setup_catchsig(regsigs, (int) (sizeof(regsigs)/sizeof(*regsigs)));
- }
-}
-
-#if has_mmap && large_memory && mmap_signal
-
- /*
- * If you mmap an NFS file, and someone on another client removes the last
- * link to that file, and you later reference an uncached part of that file,
- * you'll get a SIGBUS or SIGSEGV (depending on the operating system).
- * Catch the signal and report the problem to the user.
- * Unfortunately, there's no portable way to differentiate between this
- * problem and actual bugs in the program.
- * This NFS problem is rare, thank goodness.
- *
- * This can also occur if someone truncates the file, even without NFS.
- */
-
- static int const mmapsigs[] = { mmap_signal };
-
- void
- catchmmapints()
- {
- static int catching_mmap_ints;
- if (!catching_mmap_ints) {
- catching_mmap_ints = true;
- setup_catchsig(mmapsigs, (int)(sizeof(mmapsigs)/sizeof(*mmapsigs)));
- }
- }
-#endif
-
-#endif /* has_signal */
-
-
- void
-fastcopy(inf,outf)
- register RILE *inf;
- FILE *outf;
-/* Function: copies the remainder of file inf to outf.
- */
-{
-#if large_memory
-# if maps_memory
- awrite((char const*)inf->ptr, (size_t)(inf->lim - inf->ptr), outf);
- inf->ptr = inf->lim;
-# else
- for (;;) {
- awrite((char const*)inf->ptr, (size_t)(inf->readlim - inf->ptr), outf);
- inf->ptr = inf->readlim;
- if (inf->ptr == inf->lim)
- break;
- VOID Igetmore(inf);
- }
-# endif
-#else
- char buf[BUFSIZ*8];
- register fread_type rcount;
-
- /*now read the rest of the file in blocks*/
- while (!feof(inf)) {
- if (!(rcount = Fread(buf,sizeof(*buf),sizeof(buf),inf))) {
- testIerror(inf);
- return;
- }
- awrite(buf, (size_t)rcount, outf);
- }
-#endif
-}
-
-#ifndef SSIZE_MAX
- /* This does not work in #ifs, but it's good enough for us. */
- /* Underestimating SSIZE_MAX may slow us down, but it won't break us. */
-# define SSIZE_MAX ((unsigned)-1 >> 1)
-#endif
-
- void
-awrite(buf, chars, f)
- char const *buf;
- size_t chars;
- FILE *f;
-{
- /* Posix 1003.1-1990 ssize_t hack */
- while (SSIZE_MAX < chars) {
- if (Fwrite(buf, sizeof(*buf), SSIZE_MAX, f) != SSIZE_MAX)
- Oerror();
- buf += SSIZE_MAX;
- chars -= SSIZE_MAX;
- }
-
- if (Fwrite(buf, sizeof(*buf), chars, f) != chars)
- Oerror();
-}
-
-/* dup a file descriptor; the result must not be stdin, stdout, or stderr. */
- static int dupSafer P((int));
- static int
-dupSafer(fd)
- int fd;
-{
-# ifdef F_DUPFD
- return fcntl(fd, F_DUPFD, STDERR_FILENO + 1);
-# else
- int e, f, i, used = 0;
- while (STDIN_FILENO <= (f = dup(fd)) && f <= STDERR_FILENO)
- used |= 1<<f;
- e = errno;
- for (i = STDIN_FILENO; i <= STDERR_FILENO; i++)
- if (used & (1<<i))
- VOID close(i);
- errno = e;
- return f;
-# endif
-}
-
-/* Renumber a file descriptor so that it's not stdin, stdout, or stderr. */
- int
-fdSafer(fd)
- int fd;
-{
- if (STDIN_FILENO <= fd && fd <= STDERR_FILENO) {
- int f = dupSafer(fd);
- int e = errno;
- VOID close(fd);
- errno = e;
- fd = f;
- }
- return fd;
-}
-
-/* Like fopen, except the result is never stdin, stdout, or stderr. */
- FILE *
-fopenSafer(filename, type)
- char const *filename;
- char const *type;
-{
- FILE *stream = fopen(filename, type);
- if (stream) {
- int fd = fileno(stream);
- if (STDIN_FILENO <= fd && fd <= STDERR_FILENO) {
- int f = dupSafer(fd);
- if (f < 0) {
- int e = errno;
- VOID fclose(stream);
- errno = e;
- return 0;
- }
- if (fclose(stream) != 0) {
- int e = errno;
- VOID close(f);
- errno = e;
- return 0;
- }
- stream = fdopen(f, type);
- }
- }
- return stream;
-}
-
-
-#ifdef F_DUPFD
-# undef dup
-# define dup(fd) fcntl(fd, F_DUPFD, 0)
-#endif
-
-
-#if has_fork || has_spawn
-
- static int movefd P((int,int));
- static int
-movefd(old, new)
- int old, new;
-{
- if (old < 0 || old == new)
- return old;
-# ifdef F_DUPFD
- new = fcntl(old, F_DUPFD, new);
-# else
- new = dup2(old, new);
-# endif
- return close(old)==0 ? new : -1;
-}
-
- static int fdreopen P((int,char const*,int));
- static int
-fdreopen(fd, file, flags)
- int fd;
- char const *file;
- int flags;
-{
- int newfd;
- VOID close(fd);
- newfd =
-#if !open_can_creat
- flags&O_CREAT ? creat(file, S_IRUSR|S_IWUSR) :
-#endif
- open(file, flags, S_IRUSR|S_IWUSR);
- return movefd(newfd, fd);
-}
-
-#if has_spawn
- static void redirect P((int,int));
- static void
-redirect(old, new)
- int old, new;
-/*
-* Move file descriptor OLD to NEW.
-* If OLD is -1, do nothing.
-* If OLD is -2, just close NEW.
-*/
-{
- if ((old != -1 && close(new) != 0) || (0 <= old && movefd(old,new) < 0))
- efaterror("spawn I/O redirection");
-}
-#endif
-
-
-#else /* !has_fork && !has_spawn */
-
- static void bufargcat P((struct buf*,int,char const*));
- static void
-bufargcat(b, c, s)
- register struct buf *b;
- int c;
- register char const *s;
-/* Append to B a copy of C, plus a quoted copy of S. */
-{
- register char *p;
- register char const *t;
- size_t bl, sl;
-
- for (t=s, sl=0; *t; )
- sl += 3*(*t++=='\'') + 1;
- bl = strlen(b->string);
- bufrealloc(b, bl + sl + 4);
- p = b->string + bl;
- *p++ = c;
- *p++ = '\'';
- while (*s) {
- if (*s == '\'') {
- *p++ = '\'';
- *p++ = '\\';
- *p++ = '\'';
- }
- *p++ = *s++;
- }
- *p++ = '\'';
- *p = 0;
-}
-
-#endif
-
-#if !has_spawn && has_fork
-/*
-* Output the string S to stderr, without touching any I/O buffers.
-* This is useful if you are a child process, whose buffers are usually wrong.
-* Exit immediately if the write does not completely succeed.
-*/
-static void write_stderr P((char const *));
- static void
-write_stderr(s)
- char const *s;
-{
- size_t slen = strlen(s);
- if (write(STDERR_FILENO, s, slen) != slen)
- _exit(EXIT_TROUBLE);
-}
-#endif
-
-/*
-* Run a command.
-* infd, if not -1, is the input file descriptor.
-* outname, if nonzero, is the name of the output file.
-* args[1..] form the command to be run; args[0] might be modified.
-*/
- int
-runv(infd, outname, args)
- int infd;
- char const *outname, **args;
-{
- int wstatus;
-
-#if bad_wait_if_SIGCHLD_ignored
- static int fixed_SIGCHLD;
- if (!fixed_SIGCHLD) {
- fixed_SIGCHLD = true;
-# ifndef SIGCHLD
-# define SIGCHLD SIGCLD
-# endif
- VOID signal(SIGCHLD, SIG_DFL);
- }
-#endif
-
- oflush();
- eflush();
- {
-#if has_spawn
- int in, out;
- char const *file;
-
- in = -1;
- if (infd != -1 && infd != STDIN_FILENO) {
- if ((in = dup(STDIN_FILENO)) < 0) {
- if (errno != EBADF)
- efaterror("spawn input setup");
- in = -2;
- } else {
-# ifdef F_DUPFD
- if (close(STDIN_FILENO) != 0)
- efaterror("spawn input close");
-# endif
- }
- if (
-# ifdef F_DUPFD
- fcntl(infd, F_DUPFD, STDIN_FILENO) != STDIN_FILENO
-# else
- dup2(infd, STDIN_FILENO) != STDIN_FILENO
-# endif
- )
- efaterror("spawn input redirection");
- }
-
- out = -1;
- if (outname) {
- if ((out = dup(STDOUT_FILENO)) < 0) {
- if (errno != EBADF)
- efaterror("spawn output setup");
- out = -2;
- }
- if (fdreopen(
- STDOUT_FILENO, outname,
- O_CREAT | O_TRUNC | O_WRONLY
- ) < 0)
- efaterror(outname);
- }
-
- wstatus = spawn_RCS(0, args[1], (char**)(args + 1));
-# ifdef RCS_SHELL
- if (wstatus == -1 && errno == ENOEXEC) {
- args[0] = RCS_SHELL;
- wstatus = spawnv(0, args[0], (char**)args);
- }
-# endif
- redirect(in, STDIN_FILENO);
- redirect(out, STDOUT_FILENO);
-#else
-#if has_fork
- pid_t pid;
- if (!(pid = vfork())) {
- char const *notfound;
- if (infd != -1 && infd != STDIN_FILENO && (
-# ifdef F_DUPFD
- (VOID close(STDIN_FILENO),
- fcntl(infd, F_DUPFD, STDIN_FILENO) != STDIN_FILENO)
-# else
- dup2(infd, STDIN_FILENO) != STDIN_FILENO
-# endif
- )) {
- /* Avoid perror since it may misuse buffers. */
- write_stderr(args[1]);
- write_stderr(": I/O redirection failed\n");
- _exit(EXIT_TROUBLE);
- }
-
- if (outname)
- if (fdreopen(
- STDOUT_FILENO, outname,
- O_CREAT | O_TRUNC | O_WRONLY
- ) < 0) {
- /* Avoid perror since it may misuse buffers. */
- write_stderr(args[1]);
- write_stderr(": ");
- write_stderr(outname);
- write_stderr(": cannot create\n");
- _exit(EXIT_TROUBLE);
- }
- VOID exec_RCS(args[1], (char**)(args + 1));
- notfound = args[1];
-# ifdef RCS_SHELL
- if (errno == ENOEXEC) {
- args[0] = notfound = RCS_SHELL;
- VOID execv(args[0], (char**)args);
- }
-# endif
-
- /* Avoid perror since it may misuse buffers. */
- write_stderr(notfound);
- write_stderr(": not found\n");
- _exit(EXIT_TROUBLE);
- }
- if (pid < 0)
- efaterror("fork");
-# if has_waitpid
- if (waitpid(pid, &wstatus, 0) < 0)
- efaterror("waitpid");
-# else
- {
- pid_t w;
- do {
- if ((w = wait(&wstatus)) < 0)
- efaterror("wait");
- } while (w != pid);
- }
-# endif
-#else
- static struct buf b;
- char const *p;
-
- /* Use system(). On many hosts system() discards signals. Yuck! */
- p = args + 1;
- bufscpy(&b, *p);
- while (*++p)
- bufargcat(&b, ' ', *p);
- if (infd != -1 && infd != STDIN_FILENO) {
- char redirection[32];
- VOID sprintf(redirection, "<&%d", infd);
- bufscat(&b, redirection);
- }
- if (outname)
- bufargcat(&b, '>', outname);
- wstatus = system(b.string);
-#endif
-#endif
- }
- if (!WIFEXITED(wstatus)) {
- if (WIFSIGNALED(wstatus)) {
- psignal(WTERMSIG(wstatus), args[1]);
- fatcleanup(1);
- }
- faterror("%s failed for unknown reason", args[1]);
- }
- return WEXITSTATUS(wstatus);
-}
-
-#define CARGSMAX 20
-/*
-* Run a command.
-* infd, if not -1, is the input file descriptor.
-* outname, if nonzero, is the name of the output file.
-* The remaining arguments specify the command and its arguments.
-*/
- int
-#if has_prototypes
-run(int infd, char const *outname, ...)
-#else
- /*VARARGS2*/
-run(infd, outname, va_alist)
- int infd;
- char const *outname;
- va_dcl
-#endif
-{
- va_list ap;
- char const *rgargs[CARGSMAX];
- register int i;
- vararg_start(ap, outname);
- for (i = 1; (rgargs[i++] = va_arg(ap, char const*)); )
- if (CARGSMAX <= i)
- faterror("too many command arguments");
- va_end(ap);
- return runv(infd, outname, rgargs);
-}
-
-
-int RCSversion;
-
- void
-setRCSversion(str)
- char const *str;
-{
- static int oldversion;
-
- register char const *s = str + 2;
-
- if (*s) {
- int v = VERSION_DEFAULT;
-
- if (oldversion)
- redefined('V');
- oldversion = true;
- v = 0;
- while (isdigit(*s))
- v = 10*v + *s++ - '0';
- if (*s)
- error("%s isn't a number", str);
- else if (v < VERSION_min || VERSION_max < v)
- error("%s out of range %d..%d",
- str, VERSION_min, VERSION_max
- );
-
- RCSversion = VERSION(v);
- } else {
- printf("RCS version %s\n", RCS_version_string);
- exit(0);
- }
-}
-
- int
-getRCSINIT(argc, argv, newargv)
- int argc;
- char **argv, ***newargv;
-{
- register char *p, *q, **pp;
- char const *ev;
- size_t n;
-
- if ((ev = cgetenv("RCSLOCALID")))
- setRCSLocalId(ev);
-
- if ((ev = cgetenv("RCSINCEXC")))
- setIncExc(ev);
-
- if (!(q = cgetenv("RCSINIT")))
- *newargv = argv;
- else {
- n = argc + 2;
- /*
- * Count spaces in RCSINIT to allocate a new arg vector.
- * This is an upper bound, but it's OK even if too large.
- */
- for (p = q; ; ) {
- switch (*p++) {
- default:
- continue;
-
- case ' ':
- case '\b': case '\f': case '\n':
- case '\r': case '\t': case '\v':
- n++;
- continue;
-
- case '\0':
- break;
- }
- break;
- }
- *newargv = pp = tnalloc(char*, n);
- *pp++ = *argv++; /* copy program name */
- for (p = q; ; ) {
- for (;;) {
- switch (*q) {
- case '\0':
- goto copyrest;
-
- case ' ':
- case '\b': case '\f': case '\n':
- case '\r': case '\t': case '\v':
- q++;
- continue;
- }
- break;
- }
- *pp++ = p;
- ++argc;
- for (;;) {
- switch ((*p++ = *q++)) {
- case '\0':
- goto copyrest;
-
- case '\\':
- if (!*q)
- goto copyrest;
- p[-1] = *q++;
- continue;
-
- default:
- continue;
-
- case ' ':
- case '\b': case '\f': case '\n':
- case '\r': case '\t': case '\v':
- break;
- }
- break;
- }
- p[-1] = '\0';
- }
- copyrest:
- while ((*pp++ = *argv++))
- continue;
- }
- return argc;
-}
-
-
-#define cacheid(E) static uid_t i; static int s; if (!s){ s=1; i=(E); } return i
-
-#if has_getuid
- uid_t ruid() { cacheid(getuid()); }
-#endif
-#if has_setuid
- uid_t euid() { cacheid(geteuid()); }
-#endif
-
-
-#if has_setuid
-
-/*
- * Setuid execution really works only with Posix 1003.1a Draft 5 seteuid(),
- * because it lets us switch back and forth between arbitrary users.
- * If seteuid() doesn't work, we fall back on setuid(),
- * which works if saved setuid is supported,
- * unless the real or effective user is root.
- * This area is such a mess that we always check switches at runtime.
- */
-
- static void
-#if has_prototypes
-set_uid_to(uid_t u)
-#else
- set_uid_to(u) uid_t u;
-#endif
-/* Become user u. */
-{
- static int looping;
-
- if (euid() == ruid())
- return;
-#if (has_fork||has_spawn) && DIFF_ABSOLUTE
-# if has_setreuid
- if (setreuid(u==euid() ? ruid() : euid(), u) != 0)
- efaterror("setuid");
-# else
- if (seteuid(u) != 0)
- efaterror("setuid");
-# endif
-#endif
- if (geteuid() != u) {
- if (looping)
- return;
- looping = true;
- faterror("root setuid not supported" + (u?5:0));
- }
-}
-
-static int stick_with_euid;
-
- void
-/* Ignore all calls to seteid() and setrid(). */
-nosetid()
-{
- stick_with_euid = true;
-}
-
- void
-seteid()
-/* Become effective user. */
-{
- if (!stick_with_euid)
- set_uid_to(euid());
-}
-
- void
-setrid()
-/* Become real user. */
-{
- if (!stick_with_euid)
- set_uid_to(ruid());
-}
-#endif
-
- time_t
-now()
-{
- static time_t t;
- if (!t && time(&t) == -1)
- efaterror("time");
- return t;
-}
diff --git a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/version.c b/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/version.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 81f5585..0000000
--- a/gnu/usr.bin/rcs/lib/version.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,2 +0,0 @@
-#include "rcsbase.h"
-char const RCS_version_string[] = "5.7";
OpenPOWER on IntegriCloud